blob: c81d57864020f6f2ea0242d56a6ce9499b6e8c1d [file] [log] [blame]
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001//===- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes --------------===//
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000016#include "clang/AST/APValue.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000017#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTTypeTraits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000020#include "clang/AST/AttrIterator.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000021#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000022#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000023#include "clang/AST/Decl.h"
24#include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000025#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000026#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000027#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000028#include "clang/AST/DeclOpenMP.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000029#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000030#include "clang/AST/DeclarationName.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000031#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000032#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000033#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000034#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000035#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000036#include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h"
37#include "clang/AST/RawCommentList.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000038#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000039#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000040#include "clang/AST/Stmt.h"
41#include "clang/AST/TemplateBase.h"
42#include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h"
43#include "clang/AST/Type.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000044#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000045#include "clang/AST/UnresolvedSet.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000046#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000047#include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000048#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000049#include "clang/Basic/CommentOptions.h"
50#include "clang/Basic/IdentifierTable.h"
51#include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
52#include "clang/Basic/LangOptions.h"
53#include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h"
54#include "clang/Basic/ObjCRuntime.h"
55#include "clang/Basic/SanitizerBlacklist.h"
56#include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000057#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000058#include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h"
59#include "clang/Basic/TargetCXXABI.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000060#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000061#include "clang/Basic/XRayLists.h"
62#include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
63#include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h"
64#include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
65#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
66#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
67#include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
68#include "llvm/ADT/None.h"
69#include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
70#include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
71#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
72#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
73#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000074#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000075#include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000076#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000077#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000078#include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
79#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
80#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000081#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000082#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000083#include <algorithm>
84#include <cassert>
85#include <cstddef>
86#include <cstdint>
87#include <cstdlib>
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000088#include <map>
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000089#include <memory>
90#include <string>
91#include <tuple>
92#include <utility>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000093
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000094using namespace clang;
95
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000096unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
97unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000098unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
99unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +0000100unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
101unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +0000102unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
103unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +0000104unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
105unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000106unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
107unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
108
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +0000109enum FloatingRank {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +0000110 Float16Rank, HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +0000111};
112
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +0000113RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000114 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
115 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +0000116
117#ifndef NDEBUG
118 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
119 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
120 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
121#endif
122
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000123 CommentsLoaded = true;
124 }
125
126 assert(D);
127
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +0000128 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
129 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000130 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +0000131
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000132 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
133 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
134 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000135 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000136 }
137
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000138 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
139 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
140 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000141 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000142 }
143
144 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
145 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000146 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000147 }
148
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000149 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
150 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
151 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
152 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
153 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000154 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000155 }
156
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000157 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
158 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000159 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000160 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000161 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
162 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
163 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
164 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000165 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000166 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
168 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000169 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000170
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000171 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
172 // documentation.
173 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
174 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
175 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000176 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000177
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000178 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000179
180 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
181 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000182 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000183
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000184 // Find declaration location.
185 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
186 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
187 // location".
188 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
189 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
190 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
191 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000192 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000193 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
194 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000195 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000196 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000197 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000198 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
199 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
200 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
201 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
202 // the "declaration location".
203 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
204 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
205 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
206 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
207 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
208 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
209 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
210 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
211 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
212 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
213 }
214 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000215 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000216
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000217 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
218 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000219 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000220 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000221
222 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000223 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
224 {
225 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
226 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
227 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000228 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
229 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
230 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000231 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
232 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
233 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
234 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
235 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
236 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
237 }
238
239 if (Found) {
240 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
241 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
242 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
243 } else {
244 // Slow path.
245 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
246 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
247 }
248 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000249
250 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
251 // file buffer.
252 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
253
254 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
255 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000257 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000258 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000259 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000260 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000261 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
262 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
263 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
264 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
265 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
266 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000267 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000268 }
269 }
270
271 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
272 // Let's look at the previous comment.
273 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000274 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000275 --Comment;
276
277 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000278 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000279 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000280
281 // Decompose the end of the comment.
282 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000283 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000284
285 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
286 // aren't related.
287 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000288 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000289
290 // Get the corresponding buffer.
291 bool Invalid = false;
292 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
293 &Invalid).data();
294 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000295 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000296
297 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
298 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
299 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
300
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000301 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
302 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000303 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000304 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000305
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000306 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000307}
308
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000309/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
310/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000311/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000312static const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000313 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000314 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000315 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000316 return FTD;
317
318 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
319 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
320 return D;
321
322 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
323 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
324 return FTD;
325
326 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
327 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
328 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
329 return MemberDecl;
330
331 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000332 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
334 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
335 // template?
336 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
337 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
338 return MemberDecl;
339
340 return D;
341 }
342 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
343 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
344 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
345 return CTD;
346
347 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
348 // specialization?
349 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
350 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
351 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
352 return D;
353 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
354 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
355 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
356 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
357 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
358 static_cast<const Decl*>(
359 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
360 }
361
362 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
363 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
364 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
365 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
366
367 return D;
368 }
369 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
370 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
371 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
372 return MemberDecl;
373
374 return D;
375 }
376 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000377 return D;
378}
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000379
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000380const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
381 const Decl *D,
382 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000383 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000384
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000385 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
386 {
387 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
388 RedeclComments.find(D);
389 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
390 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000391 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
392 if (OriginalDecl)
393 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000395 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000396 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000397 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000399 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000400 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
401 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000402 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000403 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000404 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000405 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
406 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
407 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
408 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000409 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000410 break;
411 }
412 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000413 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
414 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000415 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
416 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000417 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
418 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000419 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000420 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000421 } else
422 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000423 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
424 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000425 if (RC)
426 break;
427 }
428 }
429
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000430 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
431 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000432
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000433 if (OriginalDecl)
434 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
435
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000436 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
437 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
438 Raw.setRaw(RC);
439 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000440 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000441
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000442 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
443 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000444 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
445 R = Raw;
446 }
447
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000448 return RC;
449}
450
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000451static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
452 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
453 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
454 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
455 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
456 if (!ID)
457 return;
458 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000459 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000461 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
463 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
464 }
465 }
466}
467
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000468comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
469 const Decl *D) const {
470 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
471 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
472 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
473 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
474 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000475 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
476 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000477 comments::FullComment *CFC =
478 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
479 ThisDeclInfo);
480 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000481}
482
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000483comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
484 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000485 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000486}
487
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000488comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
489 const Decl *D,
490 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000491 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000492 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000493 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000494
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000495 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
496 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
497 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000498
499 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000500 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000501 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000502 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000503 return CFC;
504 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000505 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000506 }
507
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000508 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000509
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000510 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000511 if (!RC) {
512 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000513 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000514 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000515 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
516 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
517 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
518 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000519 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000520 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
521 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000522 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
523 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
524 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000525 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000526 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000527 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000528 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000529 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000530 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
531 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
532 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000533 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000534 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000535 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
536 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
537 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
538 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
539 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
540 }
541 }
542 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
543 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
544 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
545 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
546 }
547 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
548 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000549 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000550 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000551 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
552 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000553 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000554 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000555 if (Ty.isNull())
556 continue;
557 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
558 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
559 continue;
560
561 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
562 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
563 }
564 }
565 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000566 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
567 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000568 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000569 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000570 if (Ty.isNull())
571 continue;
572 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
573 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
574 continue;
575 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
576 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
577 }
578 }
579 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000580 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000581 }
582
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000583 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
584 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
585 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
586 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000587 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000588 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000589
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000590 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000591 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
592 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000593}
594
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000595void
596ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
597 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
598 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
599 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000600 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601
602 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
603 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
604 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
605 PEnd = Params->end();
606 P != PEnd; ++P) {
607 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
608 ID.AddInteger(0);
609 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
610 continue;
611 }
612
613 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
614 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000615 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000616 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000617 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
618 ID.AddBoolean(true);
619 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000620 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
621 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
622 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
623 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000624 } else
625 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000626 continue;
627 }
628
629 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
630 ID.AddInteger(2);
631 Profile(ID, TTP);
632 }
633}
634
635TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
636ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000637 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000638 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
639 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
640 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000641 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000642 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
643 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
644 if (Canonical)
645 return Canonical->getParam();
646
647 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
648 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000649 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
651 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
652 PEnd = Params->end();
653 P != PEnd; ++P) {
654 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
655 CanonParams.push_back(
656 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000657 SourceLocation(),
658 SourceLocation(),
659 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000660 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000661 TTP->isParameterPack()));
662 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000663 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
664 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
665 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
666 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
667 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000668 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
669 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000670 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
671 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
672 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
673 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
674 }
675
676 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000677 SourceLocation(),
678 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000679 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000680 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000681 T,
682 TInfo,
David Majnemerdfecf1a2016-07-06 04:19:16 +0000683 ExpandedTypes,
684 ExpandedTInfos);
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000685 } else {
686 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000687 SourceLocation(),
688 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000689 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000690 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000691 T,
692 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
693 TInfo);
694 }
695 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
696
697 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000698 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
699 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
700 }
701
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000702 assert(!TTP->getRequiresClause() &&
703 "Unexpected requires-clause on template template-parameter");
George Burgess IVb7e4e482016-08-25 01:54:37 +0000704 Expr *const CanonRequiresClause = nullptr;
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000705
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000706 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
707 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
708 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000709 TTP->getPosition(),
710 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000711 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000712 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
713 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000714 CanonParams,
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000715 SourceLocation(),
716 CanonRequiresClause));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000717
718 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
719 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000720 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000721 (void)Canonical;
722
723 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
724 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
725 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
726 return CanonTTP;
727}
728
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000729CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000730 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000731
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000732 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000733 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000734 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000735 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000736 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000737 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000738 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000739 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000740 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000741 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000742 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000743 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
744 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000745 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000746}
747
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +0000748static const LangASMap *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
749 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000750 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
751 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
752 // language-specific address space.
753 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +0000754 0, // Default
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000755 1, // opencl_global
Egor Churaev28f00aa2016-12-23 16:11:25 +0000756 3, // opencl_local
757 2, // opencl_constant
Yaxun Liub7318e02017-10-13 03:37:48 +0000758 0, // opencl_private
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000759 4, // opencl_generic
760 5, // cuda_device
761 6, // cuda_constant
762 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000763 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000764 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000765 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000766 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000767 }
768}
769
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000770static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
771 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
772 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000773 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
774 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
775 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
776 return true;
777 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
778 return false;
779 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000780 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000781}
782
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000783ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000784 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000785 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000786 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
787 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000788 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000789 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Dean Michael Berris835832d2017-03-30 00:29:36 +0000790 XRayFilter(new XRayFunctionFilter(LangOpts.XRayAlwaysInstrumentFiles,
791 LangOpts.XRayNeverInstrumentFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000792 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000793 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), Comments(SM),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000794 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000795 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
796}
797
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000798ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000799 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
800
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000801 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
802 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
803 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000804
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000805 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000806 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
807 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000808
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000809 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000810 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
811 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
812 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
813 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
814 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
815 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
816 R->Destroy(*this);
817
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000818 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
819 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
820 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
821 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
822 R->Destroy(*this);
823 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000824
825 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
826 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
827 A != AEnd; ++A)
828 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000829
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000830 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
831 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
832 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
833
Richard Smith423f46f2016-07-20 21:38:26 +0000834 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
835 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000836}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000837
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000838void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000839 if (!PointerParents) return;
840 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
841 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
842 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
843 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
844 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
845 }
846 }
847 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000848 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
849 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000850 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000851 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
852 }
853 }
854}
855
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000856void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000857 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000858}
859
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000860void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000861ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
Benjamin Kramerd6da1a02016-06-12 20:05:23 +0000862 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000863}
864
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000865void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000866 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
867 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000868
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000869 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000871#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
872#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
873 0 // Extra
874 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000875
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000876 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
877 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000878 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000879 }
880
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000881 unsigned Idx = 0;
882 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
883#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
884 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000885 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
886 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000887 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
888 ++Idx;
889#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
890#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000891
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000892 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
893
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000894 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000895 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
896 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
897 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
898 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
899 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
900 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000901 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000902 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
903 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
904 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
905 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
906 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
907 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000908 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000909 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
910 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
911 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
912 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
913 << NumImplicitDestructors
914 << " implicit destructors created\n";
915
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000916 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000917 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000918 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
919 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000920
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000921 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000922}
923
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000924void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
925 bool NotifyListeners) {
926 if (NotifyListeners)
927 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
928 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
929
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000930 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
931 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
932 else
Richard Smith90dc5252017-06-23 01:04:34 +0000933 ND->setVisibleDespiteOwningModule();
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000934}
935
936void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
937 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
938 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
939 return;
940
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000941 auto &Merged = It->second;
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000942 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
943 for (Module *&M : Merged)
944 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
945 M = nullptr;
946 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
947}
948
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +0000949void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
950 if (LazyInitializers.empty())
951 return;
952
953 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
954 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
955
956 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
957 LazyInitializers.clear();
958
959 for (auto ID : LazyInits)
960 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
961
962 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
963 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
964}
965
966void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
967 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
968 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
969 if (auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
970 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
971
972 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
973 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
974 return;
975
976 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
977 auto &Imported = *It->second;
978 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
979 Imported.resolve(*this);
980 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
981 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
982 D = OnlyDecl;
983 }
984 }
985
986 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
987 if (!Inits)
988 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
989 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
990}
991
992void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) {
993 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
994 if (!Inits)
995 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
996 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
997 IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
998}
999
1000ArrayRef<Decl*> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
1001 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
1002 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1003 return None;
1004
1005 auto *Inits = It->second;
1006 Inits->resolve(*this);
1007 return Inits->Initializers;
1008}
1009
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +00001010ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
1011 if (!ExternCContext)
1012 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
1013
1014 return ExternCContext;
1015}
1016
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +00001017BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1018ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
1019 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
1020 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
1021 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
1022 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
1023
1024 return BuiltinTemplate;
1025}
1026
1027BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1028ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
1029 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
1030 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
1031 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
1032 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
1033}
1034
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +00001035BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1036ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
1037 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
1038 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1039 getTypePackElementName());
1040 return TypePackElementDecl;
1041}
1042
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001043RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1044 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001045 SourceLocation Loc;
1046 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001047 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1048 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1049 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001050 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001051 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1052 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001053 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +00001054 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1055 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001056 return NewDecl;
1057}
1058
1059TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1060 StringRef Name) const {
1061 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1062 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1063 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1064 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1065 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1066 return NewDecl;
1067}
1068
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001069TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001070 if (!Int128Decl)
1071 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001072 return Int128Decl;
1073}
1074
1075TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001076 if (!UInt128Decl)
1077 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001078 return UInt128Decl;
1079}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +00001080
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001081void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001082 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001083 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001084 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00001085}
1086
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001087void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1088 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001089 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1090 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001091 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001092
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001093 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001094 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1095
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001096 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1097 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +00001098 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001099
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001100 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001101 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001102
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001103 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001104 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001105 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001106 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001107 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1108 else
1109 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001110 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001111 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1112 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1113 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1114 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1115 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001116
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001117 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001118 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1119 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1120 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1121 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1122 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001123
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001124 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001125 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1126 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1127 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001128
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001129 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1130 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1131
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001132 // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661-3
1133 InitBuiltinType(Float16Ty, BuiltinType::Float16);
1134
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001135 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1136 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1137 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1138
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001139 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1140 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1141 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1142 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1143 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1144 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1145 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1146 else {
1147 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1148 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1149 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001150
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001151 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1152
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001153 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1154 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1155 else // C99
1156 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1157
1158 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1159 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1160 else // C99
1161 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1162
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001163 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1164 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1165 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1166 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1167 // expressions.
1168 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001169
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001170 // Placeholder type for functions.
1171 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1172
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001173 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1174 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1175
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001176 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1177 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1178
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001179 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1180 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1181
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001182 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1183 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1184
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001185 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1186 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1187
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001188 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1189 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1190 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1191
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001192 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001193 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1194 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1195 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001196 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001197
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001198 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001199 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1200 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001201 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001202
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001203 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1204#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1205 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001206#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001207
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001208 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001209 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001210 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1211 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001212 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001213 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001214
1215 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001216 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1217 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001218
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001219 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001220
1221 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001222
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001223 // void * type
Yaxun Liu39195062017-08-04 18:16:31 +00001224 if (LangOpts.OpenCLVersion >= 200) {
1225 auto Q = VoidTy.getQualifiers();
1226 Q.setAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic);
1227 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(
1228 getQualifiedType(VoidTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Q)));
1229 } else {
1230 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1231 }
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001232
1233 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1234 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001235
1236 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1237 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001238
1239 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001240 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001241}
1242
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001243DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001244 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1245}
1246
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001247AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1248 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1249 if (!Result) {
1250 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1251 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1252 }
1253
1254 return *Result;
1255}
1256
1257/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001258void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001259 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1260 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1261 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1262 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1263 }
1264}
1265
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001266// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001267MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001268ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001269 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001270 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1271 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1272}
1273
1274ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1275ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1276 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1277 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1278 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1279 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001280
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001281 return Pos->second;
1282}
1283
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001284void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001285ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001286 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1287 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001288 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1289 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001290 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1291 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1292}
1293
1294void
1295ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1296 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1297 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1298 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1299 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001300}
1301
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001302FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1303 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1304 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1305 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001306 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1307 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001308 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001309
1310 return Pos->second;
1311}
1312
1313void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1314 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1315 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1316 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001317 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001318}
1319
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001320NamedDecl *
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001321ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) {
1322 auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001323 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001324 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001325
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001326 return Pos->second;
1327}
1328
1329void
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001330ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001331 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1332 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1333 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1334 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001335 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) ||
1336 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) ||
1337 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) &&
1338 "instantiation did not produce a using decl");
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001339 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1340 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1341}
1342
1343UsingShadowDecl *
1344ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1345 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1346 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1347 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001348 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001349
1350 return Pos->second;
1351}
1352
1353void
1354ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1355 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1356 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1357 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001358}
1359
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001360FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1361 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1362 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1363 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001364 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001365
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001366 return Pos->second;
1367}
1368
1369void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1370 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1371 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1372 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1373 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1374 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001375
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001376 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1377}
1378
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001379ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1380ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001381 return overridden_methods(Method).begin();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001382}
1383
1384ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1385ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001386 return overridden_methods(Method).end();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001387}
1388
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001389unsigned
1390ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001391 auto Range = overridden_methods(Method);
1392 return Range.end() - Range.begin();
Clement Courbet8251ebf2016-06-10 11:54:43 +00001393}
1394
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001395ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1396ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001397 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1398 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1399 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1400 return overridden_method_range(nullptr, nullptr);
1401 return overridden_method_range(Pos->second.begin(), Pos->second.end());
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001402}
1403
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001404void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1405 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001406 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001407 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1408}
1409
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001410void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1411 const NamedDecl *D,
1412 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001413 assert(D);
1414
1415 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001416 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1417 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001418 return;
1419 }
1420
1421 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1422 if (!Method)
1423 return;
1424
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001425 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1426 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001427 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001428}
1429
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001430void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1431 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1432 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1433 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1434 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1435 LastLocalImport = Import;
1436 return;
1437 }
1438
1439 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1440 LastLocalImport = Import;
1441}
1442
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001443//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1444// Type Sizing and Analysis
1445//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001446
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001447/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1448/// scalar floating point type.
1449const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001450 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001451 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1452 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001453 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001454 case BuiltinType::Float16:
1455 case BuiltinType::Half:
1456 return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001457 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1458 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1459 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001460 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001461 }
1462}
1463
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001464CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001465 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001466
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001467 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1468 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1469 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001470
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001471 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1472 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1473 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1474 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001475 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001476 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1477 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1478 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1479 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1480 } else {
1481 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1482 }
1483 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001484 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1485 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1486 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1487 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001488
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001489 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1490 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001491 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001492 // do nothing
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001493 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001494 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001495 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001496 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001497 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1498 else
1499 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1500 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001501 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
Akira Hatanakad62f2c82017-01-06 17:56:15 +00001502 if (T->isFunctionType())
1503 Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align;
1504 else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001505 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1506 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001507 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001508 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1509 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001510 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1511 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1512 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1513 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1514 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1515 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001516 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001517 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Roger Ferrer Ibanez3fa38a12017-03-08 14:00:44 +00001518 if (BaseT.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
1519 Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001520 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001521 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001522 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1523 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001524 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001525
1526 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1527 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1528 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1529 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1530 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001531 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1532 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1533 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1534 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1535 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001536
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001537 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1538 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001539
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001540 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1541 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1542 if (Offset > 0) {
1543 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1544 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1545 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1546 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1547 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1548 }
1549
1550 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001551 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001552 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001553 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001554
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001555 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001556}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001557
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001558// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1559// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1560// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1561// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1562std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1563ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1564 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1565
1566 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1567 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1568 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1569 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1570 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1571 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1572 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1573 }
1574 }
1575
1576 return sizeAndAlign;
1577}
1578
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001579/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1580/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1581std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1582static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1583 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1584 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1585 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1586 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001587 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1588 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001589 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1590 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1591 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001592 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1593 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001594 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001595 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1596 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1597}
1598
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001599std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001600ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001601 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1602 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001603 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1604 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1605 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001606}
1607
1608std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001609ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001610 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1611}
1612
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001613bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1614 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1615}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001616
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001617bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1618 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1619}
1620
Richard Smithb2f0f052016-10-10 18:54:32 +00001621unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T) const {
1622 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1623 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1624 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1625 return Align;
1626
1627 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1628 T = getBaseElementType(T);
1629 if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1630 return getTypeAlign(T);
1631
1632 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1633 // type with an alignment attribute.
1634 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1635 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1636 return Align;
1637
1638 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1639 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1640 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1641
1642 return 0;
1643}
1644
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001645TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001646 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1647 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1648 return I->second;
1649
1650 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1651 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1652 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001653 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001654}
1655
1656/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1657/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001658///
1659/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1660/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1661/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001662TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1663 uint64_t Width = 0;
1664 unsigned Align = 8;
1665 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001666 unsigned AS = 0;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001667 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001668#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1669#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001670#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001671#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001672#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1673 case Type::Class: \
1674 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1675 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001676#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001677 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001678
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001679 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1680 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001681 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1682 Width = 0;
1683 Align = 32;
1684 break;
1685
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001686 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001687 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001688 Width = 0;
1689 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1690 break;
1691
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001692 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001693 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001694
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001695 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001696 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001697 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001698 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001699 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1700 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001701 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1702 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001703 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001704 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001705 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001706 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001707 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001708 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001709 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1710 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001711 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001712 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1713 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001714 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001715 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001716 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001717 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001718 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1719 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1720 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1721 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001722 break;
1723 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001724
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001725 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001726 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001727 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001728 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001729 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1730 Width = 0;
1731 Align = 8;
1732 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001733 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001734 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1735 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001736 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001737 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1738 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1739 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001740 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001741 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1742 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001743 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001744 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1745 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001746 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1747 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001748 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001749 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001750 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1751 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001752 break;
1753 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001754 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1755 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001756 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001757 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001758 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001759 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1760 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001761 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001762 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001763 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001764 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1765 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001766 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001767 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001768 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001769 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1770 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001771 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001772 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001773 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001774 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1775 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001776 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001777 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1778 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1779 Width = 128;
1780 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1781 break;
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001782 case BuiltinType::Float16:
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001783 case BuiltinType::Half:
1784 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1785 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1786 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001787 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001788 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1789 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001790 break;
1791 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001792 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1793 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001794 break;
1795 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001796 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1797 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001798 break;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001799 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1800 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
1801 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
1802 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001803 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001804 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1805 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001806 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001807 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1808 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1809 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001810 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1811 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001812 break;
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001813 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001814 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001815 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1816 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001817 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Yaxun Liu99444cb2016-08-03 20:38:06 +00001818#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1819 case BuiltinType::Id:
1820#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Sven van Haastregt3bb7eaf2017-12-06 10:11:28 +00001821 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1822 Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T)));
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001823 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1824 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1825 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001826 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001827 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001828 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001829 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1830 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001831 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001832 case Type::BlockPointer:
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001833 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001834 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1835 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001836 break;
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001837 case Type::LValueReference:
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001838 case Type::RValueReference:
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001839 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1840 // the pointer route.
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001841 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001842 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1843 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001844 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001845 case Type::Pointer:
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001846 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001847 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1848 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001849 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001850 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001851 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00001852 CXXABI::MemberPointerInfo MPI = ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT);
1853 Width = MPI.Width;
1854 Align = MPI.Align;
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001855 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001856 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001857 case Type::Complex: {
1858 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1859 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001860 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1861 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1862 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001863 break;
1864 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001865 case Type::ObjCObject:
1866 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001867 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001868 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001869 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001870 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001871 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001872 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001873 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001874 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001875 break;
1876 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001877 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001878 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001879 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1880
1881 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001882 Width = 8;
1883 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001884 break;
1885 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001886
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001887 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1888 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1889 TypeInfo Info =
1890 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1891 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1892 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1893 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1894 }
1895 return Info;
1896 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001897
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001898 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001899 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1900 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001901 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001902 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001903 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001904 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001905 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001906
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001907 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001908 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1909 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001910
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00001911 case Type::Auto:
1912 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: {
1913 const DeducedType *A = cast<DeducedType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001914 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1915 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001916 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001917 }
1918
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001919 case Type::Paren:
1920 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1921
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00001922 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
1923 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1924
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001925 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001926 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001927 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001928 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1929 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1930 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001931 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001932 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001933 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001934 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001935 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001936 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1937 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001938 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001939 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001940 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001941
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001942 case Type::Elaborated:
1943 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001945 case Type::Attributed:
1946 return getTypeInfo(
1947 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1948
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001949 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001950 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001951 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1952 Width = Info.Width;
1953 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001954
1955 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1956 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1957 // favorable to atomic operations:
1958 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1959 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1960 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1961 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1962
1963 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001964 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1965 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001966 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001967 break;
1968
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001969 case Type::Pipe:
Anastasia Stulovab3398932017-06-05 11:27:03 +00001970 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
1971 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001972 break;
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001973 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001975 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001976 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001977}
1978
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001979unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1980 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1981 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1982 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1983 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1984 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1985 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1986 SimdAlign = 256;
1987 return SimdAlign;
1988}
1989
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001990/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1991CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1992 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1993}
1994
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001995/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1996int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1997 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1998}
1999
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002000/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
2001/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002002CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00002003 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002004}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002005CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00002006 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002007}
2008
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00002009/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002010/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002011CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00002012 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002013}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002014CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00002015 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002016}
2017
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002018/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
2019/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
2020/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
2021/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002022unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002023 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
2024 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002025
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00002026 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2027
2028 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
2029 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
2030 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
2031
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00002032 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
2033 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00002034
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002035 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00002036 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002037 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00002038 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2039 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002040 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00002041 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2042 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002043 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2044 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002045 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002046 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002047
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002048 return ABIAlign;
2049}
2050
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002051/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2052/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2053/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00002054unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002055 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2056}
2057
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00002058/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2059/// to a global variable of the specified type.
2060unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
2061 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
2062}
2063
2064/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2065/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
2066CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
2067 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
2068}
2069
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00002070CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2071 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2072 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2073 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2074 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2075 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2076 }
2077 return Offset;
2078}
2079
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002080/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2081/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2082/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2083/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2084/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002085void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2086 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002087 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002088 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2089 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2090 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00002091 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
2092 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00002093 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002094 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002095 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002096 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2097 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2098 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002099}
2100
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002101/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2102/// those inherited by it.
2103void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00002104 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002105 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00002106 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2107 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00002108 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002109 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00002110 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002111
2112 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00002113 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2114 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002115
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002116 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2117 while (SD) {
2118 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2119 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2120 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002121 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00002122 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002123 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002124 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002125 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002126 // Insert the protocol.
2127 if (!Protocols.insert(
2128 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2129 return;
2130
2131 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2132 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002133 }
2134}
2135
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002136static bool unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2137 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2138 assert(RD->isUnion() && "Must be union type");
2139 CharUnits UnionSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(RD->getTypeForDecl());
2140
2141 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2142 if (!Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2143 return false;
2144 CharUnits FieldSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType());
2145 if (FieldSize != UnionSize)
2146 return false;
2147 }
2148 return true;
2149}
2150
Benjamin Kramer802e6252017-12-24 12:46:22 +00002151static bool isStructEmpty(QualType Ty) {
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002152 const RecordDecl *RD = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2153
2154 if (!RD->field_empty())
2155 return false;
2156
2157 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
2158 return ClassDecl->isEmpty();
2159
2160 return true;
2161}
2162
2163static llvm::Optional<int64_t>
2164structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2165 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2166 assert(!RD->isUnion() && "Must be struct/class type");
2167 const auto &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2168
2169 int64_t CurOffsetInBits = 0;
2170 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2171 if (ClassDecl->isDynamicClass())
2172 return llvm::None;
2173
2174 SmallVector<std::pair<QualType, int64_t>, 4> Bases;
2175 for (const auto Base : ClassDecl->bases()) {
2176 // Empty types can be inherited from, and non-empty types can potentially
2177 // have tail padding, so just make sure there isn't an error.
2178 if (!isStructEmpty(Base.getType())) {
2179 llvm::Optional<int64_t> Size = structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2180 Context, Base.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2181 if (!Size)
2182 return llvm::None;
2183 Bases.emplace_back(Base.getType(), Size.getValue());
2184 }
2185 }
2186
2187 std::sort(
2188 Bases.begin(), Bases.end(), [&](const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &L,
2189 const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &R) {
2190 return Layout.getBaseClassOffset(L.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) <
2191 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(R.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
2192 });
2193
2194 for (const auto Base : Bases) {
2195 int64_t BaseOffset = Context.toBits(
2196 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()));
2197 int64_t BaseSize = Base.second;
2198 if (BaseOffset != CurOffsetInBits)
2199 return llvm::None;
2200 CurOffsetInBits = BaseOffset + BaseSize;
2201 }
2202 }
2203
2204 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2205 if (!Field->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
2206 !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2207 return llvm::None;
2208
2209 int64_t FieldSizeInBits =
2210 Context.toBits(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType()));
2211 if (Field->isBitField()) {
2212 int64_t BitfieldSize = Field->getBitWidthValue(Context);
2213
2214 if (BitfieldSize > FieldSizeInBits)
2215 return llvm::None;
2216 FieldSizeInBits = BitfieldSize;
2217 }
2218
2219 int64_t FieldOffsetInBits = Context.getFieldOffset(Field);
2220
2221 if (FieldOffsetInBits != CurOffsetInBits)
2222 return llvm::None;
2223
2224 CurOffsetInBits = FieldSizeInBits + FieldOffsetInBits;
2225 }
2226
2227 return CurOffsetInBits;
2228}
2229
2230bool ASTContext::hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(QualType Ty) const {
2231 // C++17 [meta.unary.prop]:
2232 // The predicate condition for a template specialization
2233 // has_unique_object_representations<T> shall be
2234 // satisfied if and only if:
2235 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable, and
2236 // (9.2) - any two objects of type T with the same value have the same
2237 // object representation, where two objects
2238 // of array or non-union class type are considered to have the same value
2239 // if their respective sequences of
2240 // direct subobjects have the same values, and two objects of union type
2241 // are considered to have the same
2242 // value if they have the same active member and the corresponding members
2243 // have the same value.
2244 // The set of scalar types for which this condition holds is
2245 // implementation-defined. [ Note: If a type has padding
2246 // bits, the condition does not hold; otherwise, the condition holds true
2247 // for unsigned integral types. -- end note ]
2248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "Null QualType sent to unique object rep check");
2249
2250 // Arrays are unique only if their element type is unique.
2251 if (Ty->isArrayType())
2252 return hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(getBaseElementType(Ty));
2253
2254 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable...
2255 if (!Ty.isTriviallyCopyableType(*this))
2256 return false;
2257
2258 // All integrals and enums are unique.
2259 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
2260 return true;
2261
2262 // All other pointers are unique.
2263 if (Ty->isPointerType())
2264 return true;
2265
2266 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
2267 const MemberPointerType *MPT = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2268 return !ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT).HasPadding;
2269 }
2270
2271 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
2272 const RecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2273
Erich Keanebd2197c2017-12-12 16:02:06 +00002274 if (Record->isInvalidDecl())
2275 return false;
2276
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002277 if (Record->isUnion())
2278 return unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2279
2280 Optional<int64_t> StructSize =
2281 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2282
2283 return StructSize &&
2284 StructSize.getValue() == static_cast<int64_t>(getTypeSize(Ty));
2285 }
2286
2287 // FIXME: More cases to handle here (list by rsmith):
2288 // vectors (careful about, eg, vector of 3 foo)
2289 // _Complex int and friends
2290 // _Atomic T
2291 // Obj-C block pointers
2292 // Obj-C object pointers
2293 // and perhaps OpenCL's various builtin types (pipe, sampler_t, event_t,
2294 // clk_event_t, queue_t, reserve_id_t)
2295 // There're also Obj-C class types and the Obj-C selector type, but I think it
2296 // makes sense for those to return false here.
2297
2298 return false;
2299}
2300
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002301unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002302 unsigned count = 0;
2303 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002304 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002305 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002306
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002307 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2308 // includes synthesized ivars.
2309 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002310 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2311
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002312 return count;
2313}
2314
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002315bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2316 if (!E)
2317 return false;
2318
2319 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2320 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2321
2322 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2323 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2324 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2325 return true;
2326
2327 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2328 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2329
2330 return false;
2331}
2332
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002333/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl, or nullptr if none
2334/// exists.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002335ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2336 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2337 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2338 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2339 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002340 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002341}
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002342
2343/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or nullptr if none
2344/// exists.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002345ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2346 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2347 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2348 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2349 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002350 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002351}
2352
2353/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2354void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2355 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2356 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2357 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2358}
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002359
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002360/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2361void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2362 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2363 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2364 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2365}
2366
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002367const ObjCMethodDecl *
2368ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2369 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2370}
2371
2372void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2373 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2374 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2375 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2376}
2377
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002378const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2379 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2380 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2381 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002382 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002383 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2384 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002385 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002386 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2387 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002388 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2389
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002390 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002391}
2392
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002393/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl, or nullptr if
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002394/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002395Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002396 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2397 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2398 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002399 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002400 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002401 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002402}
2403
2404/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2405void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2406 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002407 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2408 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002409 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2410}
2411
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002412TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002413 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002414 if (!DataSize)
2415 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2416 else
2417 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002418 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002419
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002420 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2421 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2422 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2423 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002424}
2425
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002426TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002427 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002428 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002429 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002430 return DI;
2431}
2432
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002433const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002434ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002435 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002436}
2437
2438const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002439ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2440 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002441 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2442}
2443
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002444//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2445// Type creation/memoization methods
2446//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2447
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002448QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002449ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2450 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2451 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002452
2453 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2454 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002455 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002456 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002457 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2458 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2459 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002460 }
2461
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002462 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2463 QualType canon;
2464 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2465 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002466 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2467 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002468
2469 // Re-find the insert position.
2470 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2471 }
2472
2473 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2474 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2475 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002476}
2477
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00002478QualType ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,
2479 LangAS AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002480 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2481 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002482 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002483
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002484 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2485 // into one ExtQuals node.
2486 QualifierCollector Quals;
2487 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002488
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002489 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2490 // another one.
2491 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2492 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2493 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002494
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002495 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002496}
2497
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00002498QualType ASTContext::removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const {
2499 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2500 // into one ExtQuals node.
2501 QualifierCollector Quals;
2502 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2503
2504 // If the qualifier doesn't have an address space just return it.
2505 if (!Quals.hasAddressSpace())
2506 return T;
2507
2508 Quals.removeAddressSpace();
2509
2510 // Removal of the address space can mean there are no longer any
2511 // non-fast qualifiers, so creating an ExtQualType isn't possible (asserts)
2512 // or required.
2513 if (Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers())
2514 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2515 else
2516 return QualType(TypeNode, Quals.getFastQualifiers());
2517}
2518
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002519QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002520 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002521 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002522 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002523 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002524
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002525 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2526 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002527 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002528 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2529 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2530 }
2531 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002532
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002533 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2534 // into one ExtQuals node.
2535 QualifierCollector Quals;
2536 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002537
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002538 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2539 // another one.
2540 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2541 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2542 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002543
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002544 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002545}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002546
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002547const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2548 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2549 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2550 return T;
2551
2552 QualType Result;
2553 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002554 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002555 } else {
2556 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2557 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2558 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002559 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002560 }
2561
2562 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2563}
2564
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002565void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2566 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002567 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2568 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002569 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2570 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002571 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002572 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2573 FD = Next;
2574 else
2575 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002576 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002577 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2578 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002579}
2580
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002581/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2582/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2583/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2584/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002585QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2586 QualType Orig, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002587 // Might have some parens.
2588 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002589 return getParenType(
2590 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002591
2592 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2593 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002594 return getAttributedType(
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002595 AT->getAttrKind(),
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002596 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2597 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getEquivalentType(), ESI));
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002598
2599 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2600 // specification.
2601 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002602 return getFunctionType(
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002603 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2604 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2605}
2606
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002607bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,
2608 QualType U) {
2609 return hasSameType(T, U) ||
Aaron Ballmanc351fba2017-12-04 20:27:34 +00002610 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002611 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(T, EST_None),
2612 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(U, EST_None)));
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002613}
2614
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002615void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2616 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2617 bool AsWritten) {
2618 // Update the type.
2619 QualType Updated =
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002620 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(FD->getType(), ESI);
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002621 FD->setType(Updated);
2622
2623 if (!AsWritten)
2624 return;
2625
2626 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2627 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2628 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2629 // the type-as-written too.
2630 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
Stephan Bergmann8c85bca2018-01-05 07:57:12 +00002631 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002632
2633 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2634 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2635 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2636 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2637 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2638 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2639 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2640 }
2641}
2642
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002643/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2644/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002645QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002646 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2647 // structure.
2648 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2649 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002650
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002651 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002652 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2653 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002654
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002655 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2656 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2657 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002658 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002659 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002660
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002661 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2662 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002663 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002664 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002665 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002666 Types.push_back(New);
2667 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2668 return QualType(New, 0);
2669}
2670
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002671/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2672/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002673QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002674 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2675 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002676 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002677 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002678
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002679 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002680 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002681 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002682
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002683 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2684 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002685 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002686 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002687 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002688
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002689 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2690 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002691 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002692 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002693 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002694 Types.push_back(New);
2695 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002696 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002697}
2698
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002699QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2700 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2701 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002702 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002703 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2704 if (AT)
2705 return QualType(AT, 0);
2706
2707 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2708
2709 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2710 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002711 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002712
2713 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2714 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2715 Types.push_back(AT);
2716 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2717 return QualType(AT, 0);
2718}
2719
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002720QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2721 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2722
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002723 QualType Decayed;
2724
2725 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2726 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2727 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2728 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2729 // the array type derivation.
2730 if (T->isArrayType())
2731 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2732
2733 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2734 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2735 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2736 // in 6.3.2.1.
2737 if (T->isFunctionType())
2738 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2739
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002740 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2741 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002742 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002743 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2744 if (AT)
2745 return QualType(AT, 0);
2746
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002747 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2748
2749 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002750 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002751 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002752
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002753 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2754 Types.push_back(AT);
2755 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2756 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002757}
2758
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002759/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002760/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002761QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002762 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2763 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002764 // structure.
2765 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2766 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002767
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002768 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002769 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2770 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2771 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002772
2773 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002774 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2775 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002776 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002777 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002778
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002779 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2780 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2781 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002782 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002783 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002784 BlockPointerType *New
2785 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002786 Types.push_back(New);
2787 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2788 return QualType(New, 0);
2789}
2790
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002791/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2792/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002793QualType
2794ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002795 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2796 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2797
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002798 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2799 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002800 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002801 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002802
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002803 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002804 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2805 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002806 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002807
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002808 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2809
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002810 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2811 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2812 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002813 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2814 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2815 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002816
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002817 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002818 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2819 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002820 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002821 }
2822
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002823 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002824 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2825 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002826 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002827 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002828
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002829 return QualType(New, 0);
2830}
2831
2832/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2833/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002834QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002835 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2836 // structure.
2837 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002838 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002839
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002840 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002841 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2842 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2843 return QualType(RT, 0);
2844
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002845 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2846
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002847 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2848 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2849 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002850 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2851 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2852 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002853
2854 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2855 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2856 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002857 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002858 }
2859
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002860 RValueReferenceType *New
2861 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002862 Types.push_back(New);
2863 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002864 return QualType(New, 0);
2865}
2866
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002867/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2868/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002869QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002870 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2871 // structure.
2872 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2873 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2874
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002875 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002876 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2877 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2878 return QualType(PT, 0);
2879
2880 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2881 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2882 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002883 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002884 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2885
2886 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2887 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2888 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002889 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002890 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002891 MemberPointerType *New
2892 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002893 Types.push_back(New);
2894 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2895 return QualType(New, 0);
2896}
2897
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002898/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002899/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002900QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002901 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002902 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002903 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002904 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2905 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002906 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2907
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002908 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2909 // the target.
2910 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Konstantin Zhuravlyov9c1e3102017-03-21 18:55:39 +00002911 ArySize = ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getMaxPointerWidth());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002912
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002913 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002914 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002915
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002916 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002917 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002918 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002919 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002920
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002921 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2922 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2923 QualType Canon;
2924 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2925 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002926 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002927 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002928 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002929
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002930 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002931 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002932 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002933 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002934 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002935
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002936 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002937 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002938 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002939 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002940 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002941}
2942
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002943/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2944/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2945/// sizes replaced with [*].
2946QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2947 // Vastly most common case.
2948 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002949
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002950 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002951
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002952 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002953 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002954 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2955#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2956#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2957#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2958#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2959 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2960
2961 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2962 case Type::Builtin:
2963 case Type::Complex:
2964 case Type::Vector:
2965 case Type::ExtVector:
2966 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00002967 case Type::DependentAddressSpace:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002968 case Type::ObjCObject:
2969 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2970 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2971 case Type::Record:
2972 case Type::Enum:
2973 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2974 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2975 case Type::TypeOf:
2976 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002977 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002978 case Type::DependentName:
2979 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2980 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2981 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2982 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2983 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002984 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00002985 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002986 case Type::PackExpansion:
2987 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2988
2989 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2990 // further decay.
2991 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2992 case Type::FunctionProto:
2993 case Type::BlockPointer:
2994 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00002995 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002996 return type;
2997
2998 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2999 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
3000 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
3001 // optimizations available here.
3002 case Type::Pointer:
3003 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
3004 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
3005 break;
3006
3007 case Type::LValueReference: {
3008 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
3009 result = getLValueReferenceType(
3010 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
3011 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
3012 break;
3013 }
3014
3015 case Type::RValueReference: {
3016 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
3017 result = getRValueReferenceType(
3018 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
3019 break;
3020 }
3021
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003022 case Type::Atomic: {
3023 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
3024 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
3025 break;
3026 }
3027
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003028 case Type::ConstantArray: {
3029 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
3030 result = getConstantArrayType(
3031 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
3032 cat->getSize(),
3033 cat->getSizeModifier(),
3034 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
3035 break;
3036 }
3037
3038 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
3039 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
3040 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
3041 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
3042 dat->getSizeExpr(),
3043 dat->getSizeModifier(),
3044 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3045 dat->getBracketsRange());
3046 break;
3047 }
3048
3049 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
3050 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
3051 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
3052 result = getVariableArrayType(
3053 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003054 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003055 ArrayType::Normal,
3056 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3057 SourceRange());
3058 break;
3059 }
3060
3061 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
3062 case Type::VariableArray: {
3063 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
3064 result = getVariableArrayType(
3065 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003066 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003067 ArrayType::Star,
3068 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3069 vat->getBracketsRange());
3070 break;
3071 }
3072 }
3073
3074 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003075 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003076}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003077
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00003078/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
3079/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00003080QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
3081 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00003082 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003083 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003084 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003085 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
3086 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003087 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00003088
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003089 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
3090 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3091 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003092 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003093 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003094 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00003095 }
3096
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003097 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003098 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003099
3100 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
3101 Types.push_back(New);
3102 return QualType(New, 0);
3103}
3104
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003105/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
3106/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00003107/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003108QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
3109 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003110 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003111 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
3112 SourceRange brackets) const {
3113 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
3114 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003115 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
3116
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003117 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
3118 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
3119 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
3120 // because they can't be used in most locations.
3121 if (!numElements) {
3122 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
3123 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3124 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
3125 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3126 brackets);
3127 Types.push_back(newType);
3128 return QualType(newType, 0);
3129 }
3130
3131 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
3132 // also build a canonical type.
3133
3134 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
3135
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003136 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003137 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003138 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003139 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003140 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003141
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003142 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
3143 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
3144 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003145
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003146 // If we don't have one, build one.
3147 if (!canonTy) {
3148 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003149 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003150 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3151 brackets);
3152 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3153 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003154 }
3155
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003156 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
3157 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003158 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003159
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00003160 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
3161 // expression, then just use that as our result.
3162 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
3163 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003164 return canon;
3165
3166 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
3167 // of the element type.
3168 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
3169 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3170 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
3171 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
3172 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3173 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003174}
3175
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003176QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003177 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003178 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003179 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003180 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003181
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003182 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003183 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
3184 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
3185 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003186
3187 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003188 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
3189 // qualifiers off the element type.
3190 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003191
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003192 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3193 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003194 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003195 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003196 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003197
3198 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003199 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
3200 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3201 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00003202 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003203
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003204 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3205 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003206
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003207 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
3208 Types.push_back(newType);
3209 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00003210}
3211
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003212/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
3213/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00003214QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003215 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003216 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003217
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003218 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3219 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003220 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003221
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003222 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003223 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3224 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3225
3226 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3227 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3228 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00003229 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00003230 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003231
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003232 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3233 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003234 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003235 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003236 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003237 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003238 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3239 Types.push_back(New);
3240 return QualType(New, 0);
3241}
3242
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003243/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003244/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003245QualType
3246ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00003247 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003248
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003249 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3250 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003251 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003252 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003253 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003254 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3255 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3256
3257 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3258 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3259 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003260 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003261 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003262
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003263 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3264 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003265 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003266 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003267 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3268 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003269 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3270 Types.push_back(New);
3271 return QualType(New, 0);
3272}
3273
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003274QualType
3275ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
3276 Expr *SizeExpr,
3277 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003278 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003279 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003280 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003282 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003283 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
3284 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3285 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
3286 if (Canon) {
3287 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
3288 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003289 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3290 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
3291 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003292 } else {
3293 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
3294 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003295 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3296 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
3297 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003298
3299 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
3300 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3301 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
3302 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003303 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3304 } else {
3305 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
3306 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003307 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3308 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003309 }
3310 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003311
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00003312 Types.push_back(New);
3313 return QualType(New, 0);
3314}
3315
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00003316QualType ASTContext::getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType,
3317 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr,
3318 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
3319 assert(AddrSpaceExpr->isInstantiationDependent());
3320
3321 QualType canonPointeeType = getCanonicalType(PointeeType);
3322
3323 void *insertPos = nullptr;
3324 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3325 DependentAddressSpaceType::Profile(ID, *this, canonPointeeType,
3326 AddrSpaceExpr);
3327
3328 DependentAddressSpaceType *canonTy =
3329 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3330
3331 if (!canonTy) {
3332 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3333 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, canonPointeeType,
3334 QualType(), AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
3335 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3336 Types.push_back(canonTy);
3337 }
3338
3339 if (canonPointeeType == PointeeType &&
3340 canonTy->getAddrSpaceExpr() == AddrSpaceExpr)
3341 return QualType(canonTy, 0);
3342
3343 DependentAddressSpaceType *sugaredType
3344 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3345 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, PointeeType, QualType(canonTy, 0),
3346 AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
3347 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3348 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
3349}
3350
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003351/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
3352static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
3353 return T.isCanonical() &&
3354 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
3355 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3356}
3357
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003358/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003359QualType
3360ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
3361 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003362 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3363 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003364 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003365 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003366
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003367 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003368 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003369 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003370 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003371
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003372 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003373 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3374 Canonical =
3375 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003376
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003377 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003378 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3379 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003380 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003381 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003382
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003383 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003384 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003385 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003386 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003387 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003388}
3389
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003390CanQualType
3391ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3392 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3393
3394 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3395 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3396 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3397 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3398 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3399 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3400 }
3401
3402 return CanResultType;
3403}
3404
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003405static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
3406 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
3407 if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
3408 return true;
3409 if (!NoexceptInType)
3410 return false;
3411
3412 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
3413 // boolean "can this function type throw".
3414 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
3415 return true;
3416
3417 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003418 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
3419 // contained types are canonical.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003420 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003421 bool AnyPackExpansions = false;
3422 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) {
3423 if (!ET.isCanonical())
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003424 return false;
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003425 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3426 AnyPackExpansions = true;
3427 }
3428 return AnyPackExpansions;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003429 }
3430
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003431 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
3432 // value-dependent.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003433 if (ESI.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept)
3434 return ESI.NoexceptExpr && ESI.NoexceptExpr->isValueDependent();
3435
3436 return false;
3437}
3438
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003439QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
3440 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
3441 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003442 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3443
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003444 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3445 // structure.
3446 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3447 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3448 *this, true);
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003449
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003450 QualType Canonical;
3451 bool Unique = false;
3452
3453 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3454 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
3455 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
3456 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
3457
3458 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
3459 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003460 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
3461 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003462 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003463 if (OnlyWantCanonical || EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type != EST_ComputedNoexcept ||
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003464 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
3465 return Existing;
3466
3467 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
3468 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
3469 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
3470 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
3471 Unique = true;
3472 }
3473
Aaron Ballmanc351fba2017-12-04 20:27:34 +00003474 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003475 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
3476 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
3477
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003478 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003479 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003480 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003481 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003482 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003483 isCanonical = false;
3484
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003485 if (OnlyWantCanonical)
3486 assert(isCanonical &&
3487 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
3488
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003489 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
3490 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
3491 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
3492 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003493 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003494 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3495 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003496 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003497
Benjamin Kramer3f515cd2016-10-26 12:51:45 +00003498 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003499 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003500 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003501
3502 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
3503 // Exception spec is already OK.
3504 } else if (NoexceptInType) {
3505 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
3506 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
3507 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
3508 // should ever look at this.
3509 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003510 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny:
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003511 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3512 break;
3513
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003514 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
3515 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
3516 case EST_Dynamic: {
3517 bool AnyPacks = false;
3518 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
3519 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3520 AnyPacks = true;
3521 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
3522 }
3523 if (!AnyPacks)
3524 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3525 else {
3526 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
3527 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
3528 }
3529 break;
3530 }
3531
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003532 case EST_DynamicNone: case EST_BasicNoexcept:
3533 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
3534 break;
3535
3536 case EST_ComputedNoexcept:
3537 llvm::APSInt Value(1);
3538 auto *E = CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr;
3539 if (!E || !E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Value, *this, nullptr,
3540 /*IsEvaluated*/false)) {
3541 // This noexcept specification is invalid.
3542 // FIXME: Should this be able to happen?
3543 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3544 break;
3545 }
3546
3547 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
3548 Value.getBoolValue() ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_None;
3549 break;
3550 }
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003551 } else {
3552 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
3553 }
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003554
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003555 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3556 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003557 Canonical =
3558 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003559
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003560 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003561 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3562 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003563 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003564 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003565
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003566 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3567 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3568 // - parameter types
3569 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003570 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003571 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003572 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3573 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003574 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003575 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003576
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003577 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3578 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3579 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003580 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003581 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003582 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003583 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003584 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003585 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003586
3587 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3588 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3589 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3590 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3591 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3592 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3593 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3594 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3595 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003596
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003597 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003598 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003599 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003600 Types.push_back(FTP);
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003601 if (!Unique)
3602 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003603 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003604}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003605
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003606QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const {
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003607 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003608 PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003609
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00003610 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003611 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003612 return QualType(PT, 0);
3613
3614 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3615 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3616 QualType Canonical;
3617 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003618 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003619
3620 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003621 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003622 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3623 (void)NewIP;
3624 }
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003625 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003626 Types.push_back(New);
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003627 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003628 return QualType(New, 0);
3629}
3630
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003631QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const {
3632 return getPipeType(T, true);
3633}
3634
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003635QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003636 return getPipeType(T, false);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003637}
3638
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003639#ifndef NDEBUG
3640static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3641 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3642 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3643 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3644 return true;
3645 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3646 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3647 return true;
3648 return false;
3649}
3650#endif
3651
3652/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3653/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3654QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003655 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003656 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3657 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3658 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003659 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003660 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3661 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3662 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3663 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003664 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003665 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003666 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3667 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003668 }
3669 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3670}
3671
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003672/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3673/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003674QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003675 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003676 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003677
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003678 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003679 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003680
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003681 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3682 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3683
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003684 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003685 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003686 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003687 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003688 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003689 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003690 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003691 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003692 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003693 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3694 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3695 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003696 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003697 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003698
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003699 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003700}
3701
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003702/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003703/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003704QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003705ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3706 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003707 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003708
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003709 if (Canonical.isNull())
3710 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003711 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003712 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003713 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3714 Types.push_back(newType);
3715 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003716}
3717
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003718QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003719 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3720
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003721 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003722 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3723 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3724
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003725 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3726 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3727 Types.push_back(newType);
3728 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003729}
3730
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003731QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003732 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3733
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003734 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003735 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3736 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3737
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003738 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3739 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3740 Types.push_back(newType);
3741 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003742}
3743
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003744QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3745 QualType modifiedType,
3746 QualType equivalentType) {
3747 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3748 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3749
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003750 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003751 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3752 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3753
3754 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3755 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3756 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3757
3758 Types.push_back(type);
3759 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3760
3761 return QualType(type, 0);
3762}
3763
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003764/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3765QualType
3766ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003767 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003768 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003769 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3770
3771 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3772 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003773 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003774 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3775 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3776
3777 if (!SubstParm) {
3778 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3779 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3780 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3781 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3782 }
3783
3784 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3785}
3786
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003787/// \brief Retrieve a
3788QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3789 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3790 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3791#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003792 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3793 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3794 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003795 }
3796#endif
3797
3798 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3799 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003800 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003801 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3802 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3803 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3804
3805 QualType Canon;
3806 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3807 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3808 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3809 ArgPack);
3810 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3811 }
3812
3813 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3814 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3815 ArgPack);
3816 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
George Burgess IVb5fe8552017-06-12 17:44:30 +00003817 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003818 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3819}
3820
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003821/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003822/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003823/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003824QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003825 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003826 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003827 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003828 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003829 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003830 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003831 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3832
3833 if (TypeParm)
3834 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003835
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003836 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003837 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003838 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003839
3840 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3841 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3842 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3843 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003844 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003845 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3846 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003847
3848 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3849 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3850
3851 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3852}
3853
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003854TypeSourceInfo *
3855ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3856 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3857 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003858 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003859 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3860 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003861 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003862
3863 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003864 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3865 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003866 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003867 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3868 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3869 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3870 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3871 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3872 return DI;
3873}
3874
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003875QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003876ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003877 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003878 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003879 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3880 "No dependent template names here!");
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003881
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003882 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003883 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
3884 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
3885 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003886
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003887 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003888}
3889
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003890#ifndef NDEBUG
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003891static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
3892 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3893 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003894 return true;
3895
3896 return true;
3897}
3898#endif
3899
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003900QualType
3901ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003902 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003903 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003904 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3905 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003906 // Look through qualified template names.
3907 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3908 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003909
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003910 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003911 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3912 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003913 QualType CanonType;
3914 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3915 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3916 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003917 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3918 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003919 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003920 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3921 IsTypeAlias = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003922 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003923 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003924
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003925 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3926 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3927 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003928 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003929 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003930 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003931 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003932 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003933 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003934 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003935
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003936 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003937 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003938}
3939
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003940QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
3941 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003942 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3943 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003944
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003945 // Look through qualified template names.
3946 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3947 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003948
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003949 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3950 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003951 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003952 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003953 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003954 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3955 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003956
3957 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3958 // exists.
3959 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3960 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003961 CanonArgs, *this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003962
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003963 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003964 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3965 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3966
3967 if (!Spec) {
3968 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3969 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3970 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3971 TypeAlignment);
3972 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003973 CanonArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003974 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003975 Types.push_back(Spec);
3976 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3977 }
3978
3979 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3980 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3981 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3982}
3983
3984QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003985ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3986 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003987 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003988 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003989 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003990
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003991 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003992 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003993 if (T)
3994 return QualType(T, 0);
3995
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003996 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3997 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3998 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003999 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4000 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004001 (void)CheckT;
4002 }
4003
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004004 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004005 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00004006 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004007 return QualType(T, 0);
4008}
4009
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004010QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004011ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004012 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4013 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
4014
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004015 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004016 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4017 if (T)
4018 return QualType(T, 0);
4019
4020 QualType Canon = InnerType;
4021 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4022 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
4023 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4024 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
4025 (void)CheckT;
4026 }
4027
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004028 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004029 Types.push_back(T);
4030 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4031 return QualType(T, 0);
4032}
4033
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004034QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4035 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4036 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004037 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004038 if (Canon.isNull()) {
4039 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Richard Smith74f02342017-01-19 21:00:13 +00004040 if (CanonNNS != NNS)
4041 Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004042 }
4043
4044 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004045 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004046
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004047 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00004048 DependentNameType *T
4049 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004050 if (T)
4051 return QualType(T, 0);
4052
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004053 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004054 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00004055 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004056 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004057}
4058
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004059QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004060ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4061 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004062 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004063 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004064 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004065 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004066 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004067 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
4068 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004069 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004070}
4071
4072QualType
4073ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4074 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4075 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4076 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004077 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00004078 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
4079 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004080
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004081 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004082 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004083 Name, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004084
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004085 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004086 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
4087 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004088 if (T)
4089 return QualType(T, 0);
4090
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004091 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004092
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004093 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
4094 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
4095
4096 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004097 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004098 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004099 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
4100 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
4101 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
4102 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004103 }
4104
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004105 QualType Canon;
4106 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
4107 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004108 Name,
4109 CanonArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004110
4111 // Find the insert position again.
4112 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4113 }
4114
4115 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
4116 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
4117 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00004118 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004119 Name, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004120 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004121 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004122 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004123}
4124
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00004125TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) {
4126 TemplateArgument Arg;
4127 if (auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) {
4128 QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP);
4129 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4130 ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, None);
4131
4132 Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType);
4133 } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) {
4134 Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr(
4135 NTTP, /*enclosing*/false,
4136 NTTP->getType().getNonLValueExprType(*this),
4137 Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation());
4138
4139 if (NTTP->isParameterPack())
4140 E = new (*this) PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(),
4141 None);
4142 Arg = TemplateArgument(E);
4143 } else {
4144 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param);
4145 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4146 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP), Optional<unsigned>());
4147 else
4148 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP));
4149 }
4150
4151 if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack())
4152 Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg);
4153
4154 return Arg;
4155}
4156
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00004157void
4158ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
4159 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) {
4160 Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size());
4161
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00004162 for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params)
4163 Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param));
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00004164}
4165
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00004166QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00004167 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004168 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00004169 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004170
4171 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
4172 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004173 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004174 PackExpansionType *T
4175 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4176 if (T)
4177 return QualType(T, 0);
4178
4179 QualType Canon;
4180 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00004181 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
4182 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
4183 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
4184 // parameters.
4185 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00004186 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004187
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00004188 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
4189 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
4190 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4191 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004192 }
4193
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004194 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4195 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004196 Types.push_back(T);
4197 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00004198 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004199}
4200
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004201/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
4202/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00004203static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
4204 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
4205 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004206}
4207
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004208static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
4209 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004210
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004211 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
4212 return false;
4213
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004214 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00004215 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004216 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004217 return false;
4218 return true;
4219}
4220
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004221static void
4222SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004223 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004224 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004225
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004226 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004227 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
4228 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
4229
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004230 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004231 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
4232 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004233}
4234
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004235QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
4236 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004237 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004238 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, {},
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004239 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
4240 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004241}
4242
4243QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
4244 QualType baseType,
4245 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004246 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4247 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004248 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
4249 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004250 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
4251 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004252 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004253
4254 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004255 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004256 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004257 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004258 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4259 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004260
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004261 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
4262 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
4263 // type.
4264 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
4265 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
4266 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
4267 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
4268 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004269
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004270 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
4271 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
4272 // canonicalized.
4273 QualType canonical;
4274 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
4275 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
4276 [&](QualType type) {
4277 return type.isCanonical();
4278 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004279 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004280 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
4281 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
4282 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
4283 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
4284 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
4285 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
4286 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
4287 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
4288 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004289 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004290 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004291 }
4292
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004293 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
4294 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
4295 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004296 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4297 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
4298 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004299 } else {
4300 canonProtocols = protocols;
4301 }
4302
4303 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004304 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004305
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004306 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004307 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4308 }
4309
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004310 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
4311 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
4312 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4313 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004314 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004315 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
4316 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004317
4318 Types.push_back(T);
4319 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4320 return QualType(T, 0);
4321}
4322
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004323/// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
4324/// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
4325/// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
4326QualType
4327ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
4328 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
4329 bool allowOnPointerType) const {
4330 hasError = false;
4331
Manman Renc5705ba2016-09-13 17:41:05 +00004332 if (const ObjCTypeParamType *objT =
4333 dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4334 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
4335 }
4336
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004337 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
4338 if (allowOnPointerType) {
4339 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr =
4340 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4341 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
4342 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
4343 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
4344 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
4345 objT->qual_end());
4346 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4347 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
4348 type = getObjCObjectType(
4349 objT->getBaseType(),
4350 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4351 protocols,
4352 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4353 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4354 }
4355 }
4356
4357 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
4358 if (const ObjCObjectType *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
4359 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4360 // known to conform.
4361
4362 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
4363 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4364 protocols,
4365 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4366 }
4367
4368 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
4369 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
4370 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
4371 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
4372
4373 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4374 // known to conform.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004375 return getObjCObjectType(type, {}, protocols, false);
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004376 }
4377
4378 // id<protocol-list>
4379 if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
4380 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004381 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, protocols,
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004382 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4383 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4384 }
4385
4386 // Class<protocol-list>
4387 if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
4388 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004389 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, protocols,
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004390 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4391 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4392 }
4393
4394 hasError = true;
4395 return type;
4396}
4397
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00004398QualType
4399ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
4400 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4401 QualType Canonical) const {
4402 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4403 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4404 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, protocols);
4405 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4406 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
4407 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4408 return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
4409
4410 if (Canonical.isNull()) {
4411 // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
4412 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
4413 if (!protocols.empty()) {
4414 // Apply the protocol qualifers.
4415 bool hasError;
4416 Canonical = applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Canonical, protocols, hasError,
4417 true/*allowOnPointerType*/);
4418 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
4419 }
4420 }
4421
4422 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
4423 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4424 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
4425 ObjCTypeParamType *newType = new (mem)
4426 ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
4427
4428 Types.push_back(newType);
4429 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
4430 return QualType(newType, 0);
4431}
4432
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004433/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
4434/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
4435/// list.
4436bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
4437 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
4438 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4439 return false;
4440
4441 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4442 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004443 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004444 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
4445 return false;
4446 }
4447 return true;
4448 }
4449 return false;
4450}
4451
4452/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
4453/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
4454/// of protocols.
4455bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
4456 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
4457 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4458 return false;
4459 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4460 if (!OPT)
4461 return false;
4462 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
4463 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004464 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
4465 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
4466 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
4467 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004468 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
4469 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
4470 bool Conforms = false;
4471 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
4472 Conforms = false;
4473 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
4474 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
4475 Conforms = true;
4476 break;
4477 }
4478 }
4479 if (!Conforms)
4480 break;
4481 }
4482 if (Conforms)
4483 return true;
4484
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004485 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004486 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
4487 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004488 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004489 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004490 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004491 break;
4492 }
4493 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004494 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004495 }
4496 return true;
4497}
4498
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004499/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
4500/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004501QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004502 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4503 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
4504
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004505 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004506 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
4507 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4508 return QualType(QT, 0);
4509
4510 // Find the canonical object type.
4511 QualType Canonical;
4512 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
4513 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
4514
4515 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004516 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4517 }
4518
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00004519 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004520 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
4521 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
4522 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004523
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004524 Types.push_back(QType);
4525 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004526 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004527}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004528
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004529/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4530/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004531QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
4532 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004533 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
4534 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004535
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004536 if (PrevDecl) {
4537 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
4538 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
4539 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4540 }
4541
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00004542 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
4543 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
4544 Decl = Def;
4545
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004546 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
4547 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
4548 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
4549 Types.push_back(T);
4550 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00004551}
4552
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004553/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
4554/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004555/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004556/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004557/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004558QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004559 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004560 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
4561 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4562 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004563
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004564 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004565 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
4566 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4567 if (Canon) {
4568 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
4569 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004570 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004571 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00004572 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004573 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004574 Canon
4575 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004576 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4577 toe = Canon;
4578 }
4579 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004580 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004581 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004582 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004583 Types.push_back(toe);
4584 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004585}
4586
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004587/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004588/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004589/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004590/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
4591/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004592QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004593 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004594 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004595 Types.push_back(tot);
4596 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004597}
4598
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004599/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
4600/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
4601/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
4602/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00004603QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004604 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004605
4606 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004607 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004608 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
4609 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004610 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004611 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4612 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004613
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004614 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004615 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
4616 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004617 if (!Canon) {
Yaron Keren633e14a2016-11-29 10:08:20 +00004618 // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004619 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004620 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004621 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004622 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4623 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004624 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004625 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4626 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004627 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00004628 Types.push_back(dt);
4629 return QualType(dt, 0);
4630}
4631
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004632/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4633/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4634QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4635 QualType UnderlyingType,
4636 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4637 const {
Vassil Vassilevbab6f962016-03-30 22:18:29 +00004638 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
4639
4640 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
4641 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4642 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4643 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
4644
4645 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4646 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
4647 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4648
4649 if (!Canon) {
4650 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
4651 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4652 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
4653 Kind);
4654 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4655 }
4656 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4657 QualType(), Kind,
4658 QualType(Canon, 0));
4659 } else {
4660 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
4661 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4662 UnderlyingType, Kind,
4663 CanonType);
4664 }
4665 Types.push_back(ut);
4666 return QualType(ut, 0);
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004667}
4668
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004669/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4670/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4671/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004672QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004673 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004674 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004675 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004676
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004677 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004678 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004679 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004680 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004681 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4682 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004683
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004684 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004685 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004686 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004687 Types.push_back(AT);
4688 if (InsertPos)
4689 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4690 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004691}
4692
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00004693/// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type
4694/// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced
4695/// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type.
4696QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(
4697 TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const {
4698 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4699 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4700 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4701 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType,
4702 IsDependent);
4703 if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST =
4704 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4705 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4706
4707 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4708 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent);
4709 Types.push_back(DTST);
4710 if (InsertPos)
4711 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos);
4712 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4713}
4714
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004715/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4716/// the given value type.
4717QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4718 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4719 // structure.
4720 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4721 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4722
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004723 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004724 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4725 return QualType(AT, 0);
4726
4727 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4728 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4729 QualType Canonical;
4730 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4731 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4732
4733 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4734 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004735 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004736 }
4737 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4738 Types.push_back(New);
4739 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4740 return QualType(New, 0);
4741}
4742
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004743/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4744QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4745 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004746 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004747 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004748 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004749 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004750 return AutoDeductTy;
4751}
4752
4753/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4754QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4755 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4756 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4757 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4758 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4759}
4760
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004761/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4762/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004763QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004764 assert(Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004765 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4766 // away const? mutable?
4767 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004768}
4769
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004770/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4771/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4772/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004773CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004774 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004775}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004776
Alexander Shaposhnikov1e898d92017-07-14 17:30:14 +00004777/// Return the unique signed counterpart of the integer type
4778/// corresponding to size_t.
4779CanQualType ASTContext::getSignedSizeType() const {
4780 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSignedSizeType());
4781}
4782
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004783/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4784CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4785 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4786}
4787
4788/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4789CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4790 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4791}
4792
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004793/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4794/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4795QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4796 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4797 return WCharTy;
4798}
4799
4800/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4801/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4802QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4803 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4804 return UnsignedIntTy;
4805}
4806
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004807QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4808 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4809}
4810
4811QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4812 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4813}
4814
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004815/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004816/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4817QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004818 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004819}
4820
Alexander Shaposhnikov195b25c2017-09-28 23:11:31 +00004821/// \brief Return the unique unsigned counterpart of "ptrdiff_t"
4822/// integer type. The standard (C11 7.21.6.1p7) refers to this type
4823/// in the definition of %tu format specifier.
4824QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const {
4825 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUnsignedPtrDiffType(0));
4826}
4827
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004828/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4829/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4830QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4831 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4832}
4833
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004834//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4835// Type Operators
4836//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4837
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004838CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004839 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4840 // qualifiers.
4841 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004842 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004843 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004844 QualType Result;
4845 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4846 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4847 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4848 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4849 } else {
4850 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4851 }
4852
4853 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4854}
4855
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004856QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4857 Qualifiers &quals) {
4858 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4859
4860 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4861 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4862 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4863 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4864 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004865 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004866
4867 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004868 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004869 quals = splitType.Quals;
4870 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004871 }
4872
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004873 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4874 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4875 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4876
4877 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4878 // can just use the results in splitType.
4879 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4880 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004881 quals = splitType.Quals;
4882 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004883 }
4884
4885 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4886 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004887 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004888
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004889 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004890 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004891 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4892 }
4893
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004894 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004895 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004896 }
4897
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004898 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004899 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004900 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004901 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4902 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4903 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4904 }
4905
4906 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004907 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004908 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4909 SourceRange());
4910}
4911
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004912/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4913/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4914/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4915/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4916/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4917/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4918/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4919/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4920bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4921 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4922 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4923 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4924 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4925 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4926 return true;
4927 }
4928
4929 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4930 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4931 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4932 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4933 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4934 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4935 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4936 return true;
4937 }
4938
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004939 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004940 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4941 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4942 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4943 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4944 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4945 return true;
4946 }
4947 }
4948
4949 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4950
4951 return false;
4952}
4953
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004954DeclarationNameInfo
4955ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4956 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004957 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4958 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4959 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004960 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004961 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4962 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004963
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004964 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4965 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4966 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4967 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4968 }
4969
4970 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4971 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004972 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004973 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004974 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4975 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004976 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004977 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4978 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4979 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4980 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4981 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4982 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004983 }
4984 }
4985
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004986 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4987 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4988 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4989 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4990 NameLoc);
4991 }
4992
4993 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4994 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4995 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4996 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4997 NameLoc);
4998 }
4999 }
5000
5001 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00005002}
5003
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005004TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005005 switch (Name.getKind()) {
5006 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
5007 case TemplateName::Template: {
5008 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005009 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005010 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005011 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
5012
5013 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00005014 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005015 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00005016
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005017 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
5018 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005019
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005020 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
5021 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
5022 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
5023 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
5024 }
5025
5026 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
5027 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
5028 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
5029 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
5030 }
5031
5032 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
5033 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
5034 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
5035 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
5036 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
5037 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
5038 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
5039 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
5040 }
5041 }
5042
5043 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00005044}
5045
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00005046bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
5047 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
5048 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
5049 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
5050}
5051
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005052TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005053ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005054 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
5055 case TemplateArgument::Null:
5056 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005057
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005058 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005059 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005060
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00005061 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00005062 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00005063 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00005064 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005065
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00005066 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
5067 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
5068 /*isNullPtr*/true);
5069
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00005070 case TemplateArgument::Template:
5071 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00005072
5073 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
5074 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
5075 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00005076 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00005077
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005078 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00005079 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005080
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005081 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00005082 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005083
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005084 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00005085 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
5086 return Arg;
5087
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005088 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
5089 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005090 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005091 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005092 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
5093 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
5094 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005095
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00005096 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005097 }
5098 }
5099
5100 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005101 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005102}
5103
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005104NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005105ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005107 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005108
5109 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
5110 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
5111 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005112 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005113 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
5114 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
5115
5116 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
5117 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
5118 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005119 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00005120 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
5121
5122 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
5123 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
5124 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005125 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00005126 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
5127 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005128
5129 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
5130 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
5131 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005132
5133 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
5134 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
5135 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
5136 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
5137 // types, e.g.,
5138 // typedef typename T::type T1;
5139 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00005140 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
5141 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005142 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005143
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00005144 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
5145 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
5146 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005147 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
5148 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005149 }
5150
5151 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00005152 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
5153 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005154 return NNS;
5155 }
5156
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00005157 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005158}
5159
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005160const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005161 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005162 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005163 // Handle the common positive case fast.
5164 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
5165 return AT;
5166 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005167
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005168 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005169 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005170 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005171
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005172 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005173 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
5174 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005175
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005176 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
5177 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00005178 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005179
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005180 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005181 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005182
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005183 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005184 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005185 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005186 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005187
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005188 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
5189 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005190 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005191
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005192 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
5193 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
5194 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005195 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005196 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
5197 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
5198 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005199 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005200
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005201 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005202 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
5203 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005204 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00005205 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005206 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005207 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005208 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005209
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005210 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005211 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00005212 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005213 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005214 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005215 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00005216}
5217
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00005218QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00005219 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
5220 return getDecayedType(T);
5221 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00005222}
5223
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00005224QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00005225 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5226 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
5227 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
5228}
5229
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00005230QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
5231 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
5232 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
5233 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
5234 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
5235 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
5236 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
5237 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5238 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
5239 T = getDecayedType(T);
5240 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
5241}
5242
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005243/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
5244/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
5245/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
5246/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
5247///
5248/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005249QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005250 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
5251 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
5252 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
5253 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
5254 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
5255 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005256
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005257 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005258
5259 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
Jordan Rose303e2f12016-11-10 23:28:17 +00005260 QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy,
5261 PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
5262
5263 // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable
5264 if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability(*this)) {
5265 Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType(
5266 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result);
5267 }
5268 return Result;
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005269}
5270
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005271QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
5272 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00005273}
5274
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005275QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
5276 Qualifiers qs;
5277 while (true) {
5278 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005279 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005280 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005281
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005282 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005283 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005284 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005285
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005286 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00005287}
5288
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005289/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005290uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005291ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
5292 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
5293 do {
5294 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00005295 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
5296 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005297 } while (CA);
5298 return ElementCount;
5299}
5300
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005301/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
5302/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005303static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005304 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005305 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005306
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005307 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
5308 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005309 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005310 case BuiltinType::Float16: return Float16Rank;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00005311 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005312 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
5313 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
5314 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005315 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005316 }
5317}
5318
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005319/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
5320/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00005321/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
5322/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005323QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
5324 QualType Domain) const {
5325 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
5326 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
5327 switch (EltRank) {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005328 case Float16Rank:
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005329 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005330 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
5331 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
5332 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005333 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005334 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005335 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005336
5337 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
5338 switch (EltRank) {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005339 case Float16Rank: return HalfTy;
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00005340 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005341 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
5342 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
5343 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005344 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005345 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005346 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005347}
5348
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005349/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
5350/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
5351/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005352/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005353int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005354 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
5355 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005356
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005357 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005358 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005359 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005360 return 1;
5361 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005362}
5363
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005364/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
5365/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
5366/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005367unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00005368 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00005369
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005370 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005371 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005372 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005373 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005374 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5375 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5376 case BuiltinType::SChar:
5377 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005378 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005379 case BuiltinType::Short:
5380 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005381 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005382 case BuiltinType::Int:
5383 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005384 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005385 case BuiltinType::Long:
5386 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005387 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005388 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
5389 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005390 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00005391 case BuiltinType::Int128:
5392 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
5393 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005394 }
5395}
5396
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005397/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
5398/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
5399///
5400/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
5401/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005402QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00005403 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
5404 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005405
5406 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
5407 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
5408 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
5409
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00005410 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005411 if (!Field)
5412 return QualType();
5413
5414 QualType FT = Field->getType();
5415
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005416 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005417 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005418 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
5419 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
5420 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
5421 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
5422 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
5423 // promotion applies to it.
5424 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
5425 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
5426 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
5427 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
5428 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
5429 //
5430 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
5431 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005432 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
5433 return IntTy;
5434
5435 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
5436 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5437
5438 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005439 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
5440 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
5441 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
5442 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005443 return QualType();
5444}
5445
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005446/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
5447/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
5448/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005449QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005450 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
5451 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00005452 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
5453 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00005454
5455 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5456 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
5457 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
5458 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
5459 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
5460 // unsigned long long int [...]
5461 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
5462 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
5463 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
5464 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
5465 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
5466 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
5467 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
5468 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
5469 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
5470 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
5471 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
5472 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
5473 (FromSize == ToSize &&
5474 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
5475 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
5476 }
5477 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
5478 }
5479 }
5480
5481 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005482 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
5483 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00005484 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
5485 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005486 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
5487 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5488}
5489
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005490/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
5491/// type and returns its ownership.
5492Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
5493 while (!T.isNull()) {
5494 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
5495 return T.getObjCLifetime();
5496 if (T->isArrayType())
5497 T = getBaseElementType(T);
5498 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
5499 T = PT->getPointeeType();
5500 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00005501 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005502 else
5503 break;
5504 }
5505
5506 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
5507}
5508
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005509static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
5510 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
5511 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
5512 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
5513 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005514 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005515}
5516
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005517/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005518/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005519/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005520int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005521 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
5522 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005523
5524 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
5525 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
5526 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5527 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
5528 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5529
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005530 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005531
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005532 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
5533 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005534
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005535 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
5536 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005537
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005538 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
5539 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
5540 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
5541 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005542
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005543 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
5544 if (LHSUnsigned) {
5545 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
5546 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
5547 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005548
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005549 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5550 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005551 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005552 return -1;
5553 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005554
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005555 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
5556 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
5557 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005558
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005559 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5560 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005561 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005562 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005563}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005564
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005565TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005566 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005567 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
5568 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
5569 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
5570 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00005571
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005572 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005573 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005574
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005575 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005576 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005577 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005578 // int flags;
5579 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005580 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005581 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005582 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005583 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005584 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005585 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005586 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005587
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005588 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005589 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005590 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00005591 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005592 SourceLocation(),
5593 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005594 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5595 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00005596 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00005597 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005598 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005599 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005600 }
5601
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005602 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5603 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
5604 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
5605 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
5606 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
5607 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005608 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005609
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005610 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
5611}
5612
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005613RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
5614 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
5615 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
5616 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
5617}
5618
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005619// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
5620QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005621 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00005622}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00005623
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005624QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
5625 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005626 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005627 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5628 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5629 }
5630 return ObjCSuperType;
5631}
5632
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005633void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005634 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
5635 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5636 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
5637 auto TagType =
5638 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5639 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5640 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005641}
5642
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005643QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005644 if (BlockDescriptorType)
5645 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5646
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005647 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005648 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005649 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
5650 RD->startDefinition();
5651
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005652 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5653 UnsignedLongTy,
5654 UnsignedLongTy,
5655 };
5656
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005657 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005658 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005659 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005660 };
5661
5662 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005663 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5664 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005665 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5666 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005667 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005668 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005669 }
5670
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005671 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005672
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005673 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005674
5675 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5676}
5677
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005678QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005679 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
5680 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5681
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005682 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005683 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005684 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
5685 RD->startDefinition();
5686
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005687 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5688 UnsignedLongTy,
5689 UnsignedLongTy,
5690 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5691 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5692 };
5693
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005694 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005695 "reserved",
5696 "Size",
5697 "CopyFuncPtr",
5698 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5699 };
5700
5701 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005702 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5703 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005704 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5705 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005706 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005707 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005708 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005709 }
5710
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005711 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005712
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005713 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005714 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5715}
5716
Sven van Haastregt3bb7eaf2017-12-06 10:11:28 +00005717TargetInfo::OpenCLTypeKind ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type *T) const {
5718 auto BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(T);
5719
5720 if (!BT) {
5721 if (isa<PipeType>(T))
5722 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Pipe;
5723
5724 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default;
5725 }
5726
5727 switch (BT->getKind()) {
5728#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
5729 case BuiltinType::Id: \
5730 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Image;
5731#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
5732
5733 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5734 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ClkEvent;
5735
5736 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
5737 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Event;
5738
5739 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5740 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Queue;
5741
5742 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
5743 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ReserveID;
5744
5745 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
5746 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Sampler;
5747
5748 default:
5749 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default;
5750 }
5751}
5752
5753LangAS ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type *T) const {
5754 return Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T));
5755}
5756
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005757/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5758/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5759/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5760bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5761 const VarDecl *D) {
5762 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5763 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5764 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5765
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005766 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005767 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005768
5769 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5770
5771 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5772
5773 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5774 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005775 switch (lifetime) {
5776 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5777
5778 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5779 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5780 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5781 return false;
5782
5783 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5784 // byref routines.
5785 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5786 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5787 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5788 return true;
5789 }
5790 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5791 }
5792 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5793 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005794}
5795
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005796bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5797 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5798 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005799 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5800 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5801 return false;
5802
5803 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005804 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005805 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5806 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005807 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5808 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5809 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5810 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005811 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005812 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005813 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005814 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005815 return true;
5816}
5817
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005818TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5819 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005820 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5821 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005822 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5823}
5824
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005825// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5826// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005827static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005828 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005829 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5830 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005831
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005832 return false;
5833}
5834
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005835/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005836/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005837CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005838 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5839 return CharUnits::Zero();
5840
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005841 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005842
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005843 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005844 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005845 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005846 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5847 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005848 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005849 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005850}
5851
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005852bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005853 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5854 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005855 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5856 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005857}
5858
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005859ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
5860ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5861 if (!VD->isInline())
5862 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
5863
5864 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
5865 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
Richard Smith8910fe62017-10-23 03:58:34 +00005866 if (First->isInlineSpecified() || !First->isStaticDataMember())
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005867 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
5868
5869 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
5870 // non-discardable definition.
5871 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
Richard Smith8910fe62017-10-23 03:58:34 +00005872 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
5873 !D->isInlineSpecified() && (D->isConstexpr() || First->isConstexpr()))
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005874 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
5875
5876 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
5877 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
5878}
5879
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005880static inline
5881std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5882 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005883}
5884
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005885/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005886/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005887std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5888 std::string S;
5889
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005890 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5891 QualType BlockTy =
5892 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5893 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005894 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005895 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5896 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5897 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005898 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005899 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005900 // Compute size of all parameters.
5901 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5902 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005903 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5904 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005905 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005906 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005907 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005908 if (sz.isZero())
5909 continue;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00005910 assert(sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005911 ParmOffset += sz;
5912 }
5913 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005914 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005915 // Block pointer and offset.
5916 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005917
5918 // Argument types.
5919 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005920 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005921 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5922 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5923 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5924 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5925 // elements.
5926 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5927 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5928 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5929 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005930 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005931 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5932 S, true /*Extended*/);
5933 else
5934 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005935 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005936 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005937 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005938
5939 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005940}
5941
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005942std::string
5943ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const {
5944 std::string S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005945 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005946 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005947 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5948 // Compute size of all parameters.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005949 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005950 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005951 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005952 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005953 continue;
5954
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005955 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
5956 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005957 ParmOffset += sz;
5958 }
5959 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5960 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5961
5962 // Argument types.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005963 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005964 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5965 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5966 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5967 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5968 // elements.
5969 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5970 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5971 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5972 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5973 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5974 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5975 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5976 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005977
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005978 return S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005979}
5980
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005981/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5982/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5983/// block object types.
5984void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5985 QualType T, std::string& S,
5986 bool Extended) const {
5987 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5988 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5989 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005990 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005991 true /*OutermostType*/,
5992 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5993 false /*StructField*/,
5994 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5995 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5996}
5997
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005998/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005999/// declaration.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006000std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
6001 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006002 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006003 // Encode return type.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006004 std::string S;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006005 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
6006 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006007 // Compute size of all parameters.
6008 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
6009 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006010 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006011 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
6012 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006013 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006014 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00006015 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00006016 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00006017 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00006018 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00006019 continue;
6020
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006021 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
6022 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006023 ParmOffset += sz;
6024 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006025 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006026 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006027 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006028
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006029 // Argument types.
6030 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006031 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00006032 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006033 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006034 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00006035 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00006036 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
6037 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
6038 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00006039 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00006040 PType = PVDecl->getType();
6041 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
6042 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006043 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
6044 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006045 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00006046 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006047 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00006048
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006049 return S;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006050}
6051
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006052ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
6053ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
6054 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
6055 const Decl *Container) const {
6056 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006057 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006058 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
6059 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00006060 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
6061 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
6062 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006063 } else {
6064 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
6065 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
6066 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
6067 return PID;
6068 }
6069 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006070}
6071
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006072/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006073/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006074/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
6075/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006076/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
6077/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
6078/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
6079/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
6080/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006081/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
6082/// @code
6083/// enum PropertyAttributes {
6084/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
6085/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
6086/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
6087/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
6088/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
6089/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
6090/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00006091/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006092/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
6093/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
6094/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
6095/// };
6096/// @endcode
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006097std::string
6098ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
6099 const Decl *Container) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006100 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
6101 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006102 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006103
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006104 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
6105 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
6106 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
6107 Dynamic = true;
6108 else
6109 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006110 }
6111
6112 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006113 std::string S = "T";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006114
6115 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006116 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
6117 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00006118 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006119
6120 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
6121 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00006122 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
6123 S += ",C";
6124 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
6125 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00006126 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
6127 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006128 } else {
6129 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
6130 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
6131 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006132 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00006133 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006134 }
6135 }
6136
6137 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
6138 // are "dynamic by default".
6139 if (Dynamic)
6140 S += ",D";
6141
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006142 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
6143 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006144
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006145 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
6146 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00006147 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006148 }
6149
6150 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
6151 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00006152 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006153 }
6154
6155 if (SynthesizePID) {
6156 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
6157 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00006158 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006159 }
6160
6161 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006162 return S;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006163}
6164
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006165/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006166/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
6167/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006168/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006169void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006170 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006171 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006172 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006173 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006174 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006175 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006176 PointeeTy = IntTy;
6177 }
6178 }
6179}
6180
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006181void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006182 const FieldDecl *Field,
6183 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006184 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
6185 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
6186 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
6187 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006188 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006189 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
6190 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006191}
6192
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00006193void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
6194 std::string& S) const {
6195 // Encode result type.
6196 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
6197 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
6198 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
6199 true /* outermost type */,
6200 true /* encoding property */);
6201}
6202
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006203static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
6204 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
6205 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006206 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
6207 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
6208 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
6209 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006210 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006211 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006212 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006213 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
6214 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006215 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006216 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
6217 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
6218 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
6219 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
6220 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00006221 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
6222 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006223 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
6224 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006225 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006226 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
6227 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
6228 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
6229 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00006230 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006231 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
6232
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00006233 case BuiltinType::Float16:
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00006234 case BuiltinType::Float128:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006235 case BuiltinType::Half:
6236 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
6237 return ' ';
6238
6239 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
6240 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
6241 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
6242 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
6243
6244 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00006245#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
6246 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00006247#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00006248 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00006249 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
6250 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00006251 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00006252 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006253 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
6254#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
6255#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
6256 case BuiltinType::KIND:
6257#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
6258 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006259 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00006260 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006261}
6262
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006263static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
6264 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
6265
6266 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
6267 if (!Enum->isFixed())
6268 return 'i';
6269
6270 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006271 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
6272 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006273}
6274
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006275static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006276 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006277 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006278 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006279 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
6280 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
6281 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
6282 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
6283 //
6284 // struct
6285 // {
6286 // int integer;
6287 // int flags:2;
6288 // };
6289 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
6290 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
6291 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
6292 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
6293 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00006294 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
Akira Hatanaka4b1c4842017-06-27 04:34:04 +00006295 uint64_t Offset;
6296
6297 if (const auto *IVD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(FD)) {
6298 Offset = Ctx->lookupFieldBitOffset(IVD->getContainingInterface(), nullptr,
6299 IVD);
6300 } else {
6301 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
6302 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
6303 Offset = RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex());
6304 }
6305
6306 S += llvm::utostr(Offset);
6307
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006308 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
6309 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006310 else {
6311 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
6312 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
6313 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006314 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006315 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006316}
6317
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00006318// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006319void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
6320 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
6321 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00006322 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006323 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006324 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006325 bool StructField,
6326 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006327 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006328 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6329 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006330 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
6331 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
6332 case Type::Builtin:
6333 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006334 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006335 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006336 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
6337 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
6338 else
6339 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006340 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006341
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006342 case Type::Complex: {
6343 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00006344 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006345 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006346 return;
6347 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006348
6349 case Type::Atomic: {
6350 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
6351 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006352 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006353 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00006354 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006355
6356 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
6357 case Type::Pointer:
6358 case Type::LValueReference:
6359 case Type::RValueReference: {
6360 QualType PointeeTy;
6361 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
6362 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
6363 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
6364 S += ':';
6365 return;
6366 }
6367 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
6368 } else {
6369 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
6370 }
6371
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006372 bool isReadOnly = false;
6373 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
6374 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
6375 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006376 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006377 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006378 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
6379 isReadOnly = true;
6380 S += 'r';
6381 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00006382 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006383 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006384 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
6385 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006386 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
6387 isReadOnly = true;
6388 S += 'r';
6389 }
6390 }
6391 if (isReadOnly) {
6392 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
6393 // combinations need to be rearranged.
6394 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006395 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00006396 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006397 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006398
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006399 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
6400 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
6401 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00006402 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006403 S += '*';
6404 return;
6405 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006406 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00006407 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
6408 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
6409 S += '#';
6410 return;
6411 }
6412 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
6413 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
6414 S += '@';
6415 return;
6416 }
6417 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006418 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006419 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006420 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
6421
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006422 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006423 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
6424 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006425 return;
6426 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006427
6428 case Type::ConstantArray:
6429 case Type::IncompleteArray:
6430 case Type::VariableArray: {
6431 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
6432
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006433 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006434 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
6435 S += '^';
6436
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006437 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006438 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
6439 } else {
6440 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006441
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00006442 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6443 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
6444 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006445 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006446 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
6447 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006448 S += '0';
6449 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006450
6451 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006452 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
6453 false, false, false, false, false, false,
6454 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006455 S += ']';
6456 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006457 return;
6458 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006459
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006460 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
6461 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00006462 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006463 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006464
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006465 case Type::Record: {
6466 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006467 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006468 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
6469 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
6470 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006471 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
6472 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
6473 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00006474 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
Serge Pavlov03e672c2017-11-28 16:14:14 +00006475 printTemplateArgumentList(OS, TemplateArgs.asArray(),
6476 getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006477 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006478 } else {
6479 S += '?';
6480 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00006481 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006482 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006483 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006484 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006485 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006486 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006487 if (FD) {
6488 S += '"';
6489 S += Field->getNameAsString();
6490 S += '"';
6491 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006492
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006493 // Special case bit-fields.
6494 if (Field->isBitField()) {
6495 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006496 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006497 } else {
6498 QualType qt = Field->getType();
6499 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6500 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
6501 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
6502 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006503 /*StructField*/true,
6504 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006505 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006506 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006507 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00006508 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006509 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006510 return;
6511 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006512
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006513 case Type::BlockPointer: {
6514 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00006515 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006516 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006517 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006518
6519 S += '<';
6520 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006521 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6522 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
6523 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006524 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
6525 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006526 // Block self
6527 S += "@?";
6528 // Block parameters
6529 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00006530 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
6531 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6532 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
6533 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006534 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
6535 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006536 }
6537 S += '>';
6538 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006539 return;
6540 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006541
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006542 case Type::ObjCObject: {
6543 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
6544 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
6545 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
6546 S += "{objc_object=}";
6547 return;
6548 }
6549 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
6550 S += "{objc_class=}";
6551 return;
6552 }
Galina Kistanovaf87496d2017-06-03 06:31:42 +00006553 // TODO: Double check to make sure this intentially falls through.
6554 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006555 }
6556
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006557 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
6558 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006559 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006560 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006561 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006562 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Akira Hatanakafd0fb202016-08-17 19:42:22 +00006563 if (ExpandStructures) {
6564 S += '=';
6565 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6566 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6567 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6568 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
6569 if (Field->isBitField())
6570 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
6571 else
6572 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
6573 false, false, false, false, false,
6574 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6575 NotEncodedT);
6576 }
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006577 }
6578 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006579 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006580 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006581
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006582 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
6583 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006584 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
6585 S += '@';
6586 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006587 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006588
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00006589 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
6590 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
6591 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
6592 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006593 S += '#';
6594 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006595 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006596
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006597 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006598 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006599 ExpandPointedToStructures,
6600 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006601 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006602 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
6603 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006604 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006605 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006606 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006607 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006608 S += '>';
6609 }
6610 S += '"';
6611 }
6612 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006613 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006614
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006615 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
6616 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006617 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
6618 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006619 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006620 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006621 // {...};
6622 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006623 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00006624 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006625 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
6626 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6627 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6628 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6629 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
6630 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006631 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006632 S += '}';
6633 return;
6634 }
6635 }
6636 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006637 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
6638 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006639 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006640 false, false, false, false, false,
6641 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006642 return;
6643 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006644
6645 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006646 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
6647 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006648 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006649 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006650 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006651 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006652 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006653 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006654 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006655 S += '"';
6656 }
6657 return;
6658 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006659
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00006660 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006661 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
6662 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006663 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
6664 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006665 case Type::Vector:
6666 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006667 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006668 if (NotEncodedT)
6669 *NotEncodedT = T;
6670 return;
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006671
6672 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
6673 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006674 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00006675 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006676 return;
6677
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00006678 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006679#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6680#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6681#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6682 case Type::KIND:
6683#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6684 case Type::KIND:
6685#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6686 case Type::KIND:
6687#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
6688 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00006689 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006690 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006691}
6692
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006693void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
6694 std::string &S,
6695 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006696 bool includeVBases,
6697 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006698 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
6699 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00006700 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006701 return;
6702
6703 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
6704 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
6705 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
6706
6707 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00006708 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
6709 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
6710 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006711 if (base->isEmpty())
6712 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006713 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006714 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
6715 std::make_pair(offs, base));
6716 }
6717 }
6718 }
6719
6720 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006721 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006722 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
6723 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006724 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
6725 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006726 }
6727
6728 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00006729 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
6730 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006731 if (base->isEmpty())
6732 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006733 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00006734 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
6735 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00006736 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
6737 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006738 }
6739 }
6740
6741 CharUnits size;
6742 if (CXXRec) {
6743 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
6744 } else {
6745 size = layout.getSize();
6746 }
6747
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006748#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006749 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006750#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006751 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6752 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6753
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006754 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6755 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006756 if (FD) {
6757 S += "\"_vptr$";
6758 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6759 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6760 S += recname;
6761 S += '"';
6762 }
6763 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006764#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006765 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006766#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006767 }
6768
6769 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6770 // Mark the end of the structure.
6771 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6772 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006773 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006774 }
6775
6776 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006777#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006778 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006779 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6780 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6781 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6782 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6783 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6784 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6785 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6786 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6787 // longer then though.
6788 CurOffs += padding;
6789 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006790#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006791
6792 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006793 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006794 break; // reached end of structure.
6795
6796 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6797 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6798 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6799 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6800 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006801 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6802 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006803 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006804#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006805 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006806#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006807 } else {
6808 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6809 if (FD) {
6810 S += '"';
6811 S += field->getNameAsString();
6812 S += '"';
6813 }
6814
6815 if (field->isBitField()) {
6816 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006817#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006818 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006819#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006820 } else {
6821 QualType qt = field->getType();
6822 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6823 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6824 /*OutermostType*/false,
6825 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006826 /*StructField*/true,
6827 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006828#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006829 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006830#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006831 }
6832 }
6833 }
6834}
6835
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006836void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006837 std::string& S) const {
6838 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6839 S += 'n';
6840 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6841 S += 'N';
6842 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6843 S += 'o';
6844 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6845 S += 'O';
6846 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6847 S += 'R';
6848 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6849 S += 'V';
6850}
6851
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006852TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6853 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006854 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, {});
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006855 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006856 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006857 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006858 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006859}
6860
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006861TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6862 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006863 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6864 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006865 }
6866 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006867}
6868
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006869TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6870 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006871 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, {});
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006872 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006873 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006874 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006875 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006876}
6877
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006878ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6879 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6880 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6881 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6882 SourceLocation(),
6883 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006884 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006885 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006886 SourceLocation(), true);
6887 }
6888
6889 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6890}
6891
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006892//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6893// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6894//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6895
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006896static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6897 StringRef Name) {
6898 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006899 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006900 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6901}
6902
6903static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6904 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6905}
6906
6907static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6908 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006909}
6910
6911static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6912 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006913 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6914 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006915}
6916
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006917static TypedefDecl *
6918CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006919 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006920 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006921 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6922 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6923 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6924 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6925 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006926 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006927 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006928 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006929 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006930 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006931 }
6932
6933 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6934
6935 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6936 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6937 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6938
6939 // void *__stack;
6940 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6941 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6942
6943 // void *__gr_top;
6944 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6945 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6946
6947 // void *__vr_top;
6948 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6949 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6950
6951 // int __gr_offs;
6952 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6953 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6954
6955 // int __vr_offs;
6956 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6957 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6958
6959 // Create fields
6960 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6961 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6962 VaListTagDecl,
6963 SourceLocation(),
6964 SourceLocation(),
6965 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006966 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6967 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006968 /*Mutable=*/false,
6969 ICIS_NoInit);
6970 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6971 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6972 }
6973 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006974 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006975 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006976
6977 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006978 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006979}
6980
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006981static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6982 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6983 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6984
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006985 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006986 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6987
6988 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6989 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6990 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6991
6992 // unsigned char gpr;
6993 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6994 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6995
6996 // unsigned char fpr;
6997 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6998 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6999
7000 // unsigned short reserved;
7001 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
7002 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
7003
7004 // void* overflow_arg_area;
7005 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7006 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
7007
7008 // void* reg_save_area;
7009 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7010 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
7011
7012 // Create fields
7013 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7014 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
7015 SourceLocation(),
7016 SourceLocation(),
7017 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007018 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7019 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007020 /*Mutable=*/false,
7021 ICIS_NoInit);
7022 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7023 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7024 }
7025 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007026 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007027 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
7028
7029 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007030 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
7031 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
7032
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007033 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
7034 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
7035
7036 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
7037 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
7038 QualType VaListTagArrayType
7039 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
7040 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007041 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007042}
7043
7044static TypedefDecl *
7045CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007046 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007047 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007048 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007049 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
7050
7051 const size_t NumFields = 4;
7052 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7053 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7054
7055 // unsigned gp_offset;
7056 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
7057 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
7058
7059 // unsigned fp_offset;
7060 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
7061 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
7062
7063 // void* overflow_arg_area;
7064 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7065 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
7066
7067 // void* reg_save_area;
7068 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7069 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
7070
7071 // Create fields
7072 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7073 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7074 VaListTagDecl,
7075 SourceLocation(),
7076 SourceLocation(),
7077 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007078 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7079 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007080 /*Mutable=*/false,
7081 ICIS_NoInit);
7082 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7083 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7084 }
7085 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007086 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007087 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
7088
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007089 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007090
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007091 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007092 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007093 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
7094 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007095 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007096}
7097
7098static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
7099 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
7100 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
Yaron Kerene0bcdd42016-10-08 06:45:10 +00007101 QualType IntArrayType =
7102 Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007103 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007104}
7105
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007106static TypedefDecl *
7107CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007108 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007109 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007110 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7111 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
7112 NamespaceDecl *NS;
7113 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7114 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
7115 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
7116 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007117 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007118 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007119 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007120 }
7121
7122 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
7123
7124 // void * __ap;
7125 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7126 VaListDecl,
7127 SourceLocation(),
7128 SourceLocation(),
7129 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
7130 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007131 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7132 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007133 /*Mutable=*/false,
7134 ICIS_NoInit);
7135 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7136 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
7137
7138 // };
7139 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
Oleg Ranevskyyb88d2472016-03-30 21:30:30 +00007140 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007141
7142 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007143 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
7144 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007145}
7146
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007147static TypedefDecl *
7148CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007149 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007150 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007151 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007152 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
7153
7154 const size_t NumFields = 4;
7155 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7156 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7157
7158 // long __gpr;
7159 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
7160 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
7161
7162 // long __fpr;
7163 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
7164 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
7165
7166 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
7167 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7168 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
7169
7170 // void *__reg_save_area;
7171 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7172 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
7173
7174 // Create fields
7175 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7176 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7177 VaListTagDecl,
7178 SourceLocation(),
7179 SourceLocation(),
7180 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007181 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7182 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007183 /*Mutable=*/false,
7184 ICIS_NoInit);
7185 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7186 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7187 }
7188 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007189 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007190 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007191
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007192 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007193
7194 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
7195 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007196 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
7197 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007198
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007199 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007200}
7201
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007202static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
7203 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
7204 switch (Kind) {
7205 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
7206 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7207 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
7208 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007209 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
7210 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007211 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
7212 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7213 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
7214 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7215 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
7216 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007217 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
7218 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007219 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
7220 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007221 }
7222
7223 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
7224}
7225
7226TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007227 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007228 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007229 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
7230 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007231
7232 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
7233}
7234
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007235Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
7236 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007237 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007238 if (!VaListTagDecl)
7239 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007240
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007241 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007242}
7243
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00007244TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
7245 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
7246 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
7247
7248 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
7249}
7250
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00007251void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007252 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00007253 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007254
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00007255 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00007256}
7257
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007258/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
7259/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007260TemplateName
7261ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
7262 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007263 unsigned size = End - Begin;
7264 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
7265
7266 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
7267 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
7268 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
7269
7270 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007271 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007272 NamedDecl *D = *I;
7273 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
7274 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
7275 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
7276 *Storage++ = D;
7277 }
7278
7279 return TemplateName(OT);
7280}
7281
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007282/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
7283/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007284TemplateName
7285ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
7286 bool TemplateKeyword,
7287 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00007288 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
7289
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007290 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007291 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7292 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
7293
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007294 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007295 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
7296 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7297 if (!QTN) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007298 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007299 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007300 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7301 }
7302
7303 return TemplateName(QTN);
7304}
7305
7306/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7307/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007308TemplateName
7309ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
7310 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007311 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00007312 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007313
7314 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7315 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
7316
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007317 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007318 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
7319 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7320
7321 if (QTN)
7322 return TemplateName(QTN);
7323
7324 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7325 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007326 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007327 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007328 } else {
7329 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007330 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007331 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007332 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
7333 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7334 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
7335 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007336 }
7337
7338 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7339 return TemplateName(QTN);
7340}
7341
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007342/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7343/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
7344TemplateName
7345ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007346 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007347 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
7348 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
7349
7350 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7351 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007352
7353 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007354 DependentTemplateName *QTN
7355 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007356
7357 if (QTN)
7358 return TemplateName(QTN);
7359
7360 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7361 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007362 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007363 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007364 } else {
7365 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007366 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007367 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007368
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007369 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
7370 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7371 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
7372 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007373 }
7374
7375 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7376 return TemplateName(QTN);
7377}
7378
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007379TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007380ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
7381 TemplateName replacement) const {
7382 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7383 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007384
7385 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007386 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
7387 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
7388
7389 if (!subst) {
7390 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
7391 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
7392 }
7393
7394 return TemplateName(subst);
7395}
7396
7397TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007398ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
7399 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
7400 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
7401 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7402 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007403
7404 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007405 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
7406 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7407
7408 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007409 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007410 ArgPack.pack_size(),
7411 ArgPack.pack_begin());
7412 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
7413 }
7414
7415 return TemplateName(Subst);
7416}
7417
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007418/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00007419/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
7420/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007421CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007422 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007423 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00007424 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
7425 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007426 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
7427 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
7428 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
7429 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
7430 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
7431 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
7432 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
7433 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7434 }
7435
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007436 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007437}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00007438
7439//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7440// Type Predicates.
7441//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7442
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007443/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
7444/// garbage collection attribute.
7445///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007446Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007447 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007448 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
7449
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007450 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007451 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
7452
7453 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
7454 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
7455 // as __strong.
7456 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
7457 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
7458 return Qualifiers::Strong;
7459 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
7460 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
7461 } else {
7462 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
7463 // pointer.
7464#ifndef NDEBUG
7465 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
7466 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
7467 CT = AT->getElementType();
7468 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
7469#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007470 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00007471 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007472}
7473
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007474//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7475// Type Compatibility Testing
7476//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00007477
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007478/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007479/// compatible.
7480static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
7481 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00007482 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007483 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007484 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007485}
7486
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007487bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
7488 QualType SecondVec) {
7489 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
7490 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
7491
7492 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
7493 return true;
7494
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007495 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
7496 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007497 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
7498 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007499 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007500 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007501 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7502 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7503 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7504 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007505 return true;
7506
7507 return false;
7508}
7509
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007510//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7511// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
7512//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7513
7514/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
7515/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007516bool
7517ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
7518 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00007519 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007520 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00007521 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
7522 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007523 return true;
7524 return false;
7525}
7526
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00007527/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
7528/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007529bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
7530 QualType rhs) {
7531 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7532 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007533 assert((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007534
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007535 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007536 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007537 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007538 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
7539 match = true;
7540 break;
7541 }
7542 }
7543 if (!match)
7544 return false;
7545 }
7546 return true;
7547}
7548
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007549/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
7550/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
7551bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7552 bool compare) {
7553 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007554 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007555 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
7556 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007557 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007558 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
7559 return true;
7560
7561 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007562 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007563
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007564 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007565
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007566 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007567 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007568 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7569 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007570 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007571 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7572 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7573 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007574 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007575 return false;
7576 }
7577 }
7578 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
7579 return true;
7580 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007581 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007582 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007583 bool match = false;
7584
7585 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7586 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7587 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007588 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007589 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7590 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7591 match = true;
7592 break;
7593 }
7594 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007595 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007596 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7597 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007598 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007599 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7600 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7601 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007602 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007603 match = true;
7604 break;
7605 }
7606 }
7607 }
7608 if (!match)
7609 return false;
7610 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007611
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007612 return true;
7613 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007614
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007615 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
7616 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
7617
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007618 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007619 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007620 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007621 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007622 bool match = false;
7623
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007624 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007625 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7626 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007627 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
7628 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007629 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007630 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7631 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7632 match = true;
7633 break;
7634 }
7635 }
7636 if (!match)
7637 return false;
7638 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007639
7640 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
7641 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
7642 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
7643 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
7644 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
7645 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
7646 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
7647 // assume that it is mismatch.
7648 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
7649 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007650 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007651 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007652 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007653 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7654 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7655 match = true;
7656 break;
7657 }
7658 }
7659 if (!match)
7660 return false;
7661 }
7662 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007663 return true;
7664 }
7665 return false;
7666}
7667
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007668/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007669/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
7670/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007671bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7672 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007673 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7674 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7675
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00007676 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007677 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
7678 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007679 return true;
7680
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007681 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7682 // __kindof types.
7683 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7684 if (succeeded)
7685 return true;
7686
7687 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
7688 return false;
7689
7690 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7691 // we can assign the other way.
7692 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7693 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
7694 };
7695
7696 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
7697 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7698 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7699 false));
7700 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007701
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007702 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
7703 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7704 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
7705 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007706
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007707 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007708 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
7709 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
7710 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007711
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007712 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007713}
7714
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007715/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00007716/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007717/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
7718/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
7719/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
7720bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7721 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007722 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
7723 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007724
7725 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7726 // __kindof types.
7727 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7728 if (succeeded)
7729 return true;
7730
7731 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
7732 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
7733 return false;
7734
7735 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7736 // we can assign the other way.
7737 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7738 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7739 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7740 BlockReturnType);
7741 };
7742
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007743 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007744 return true;
7745
7746 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007747 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7748 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007749 }
7750
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007751 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007752 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7753 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7754 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007755
7756 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7757 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7758 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7759 if (LHS != RHS) {
7760 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007761 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007762 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007763 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007764 }
7765 else
7766 return true;
7767 }
7768 return false;
7769}
7770
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007771/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7772/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7773static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7774 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7775 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007776}
7777
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007778/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007779/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7780/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007781/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7782/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7783static
7784void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007785 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007786 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7787 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007788 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007789
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007790 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7791 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7792 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7793 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007794
7795 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7796 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7797
7798 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7799 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7800 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007801 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007802
7803 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7804 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7805
7806 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7807 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7808
7809 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7810 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7811 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007812 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007813
7814 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7815 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7816
7817 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7818 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7819 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7820 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7821 }
7822
7823 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7824 // the protocols within the intersection.
7825 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7826 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7827
7828 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7829 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7830 IntersectionSet.erase(
7831 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7832 IntersectionSet.end(),
7833 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7834 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7835 }),
7836 IntersectionSet.end());
7837 }
7838
7839 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7840 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7841 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007842}
7843
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007844/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7845static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7846 QualType rhs) {
7847 // Common case: two object pointers.
7848 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7849 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7850 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7851 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7852
7853 // Two block pointers.
7854 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7855 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7856 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7857 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7858
7859 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7860 // acceptable.
7861 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7862 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7863 return true;
7864
7865 return false;
7866}
7867
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007868// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007869static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7870 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7871 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007872 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7873 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007874 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7875 return false;
7876
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007877 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007878 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007879 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7880 continue;
7881
7882 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7883 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007884 if (!stripKindOf ||
7885 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7886 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7887 return false;
7888 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007889 break;
7890
7891 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7892 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7893 return false;
7894 break;
7895
7896 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7897 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7898 return false;
7899 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007900 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007901 }
7902
7903 return true;
7904}
7905
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007906QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007907 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7908 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007909 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7910 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7911 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7912 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007913
7914 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007915 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007916
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007917 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
7918 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
7919 // kindof(A).
7920 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
7921
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007922 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7923 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7924 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7925 LHSAncestors;
7926 while (true) {
7927 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7928 // path from the LHS to the root.
7929 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007930
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007931 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7932 // Get the type arguments.
7933 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7934 bool anyChanges = false;
7935 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7936 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007937 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7938 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007939 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007940 return QualType();
7941 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7942 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7943 // arguments.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007944 LHSTypeArgs = {};
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007945 anyChanges = true;
7946 }
7947
7948 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007949 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007950 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7951 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007952 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007953 anyChanges = true;
7954
7955 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007956 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
7957 // build a new result type.
7958 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007959 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007960 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007961 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007962 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7963 }
7964
7965 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007966 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007967
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007968 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007969 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7970 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7971 break;
7972
7973 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7974 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007975
7976 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7977 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7978 while (true) {
7979 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7980 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7981 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7982
7983 // Get the type arguments.
7984 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7985 bool anyChanges = false;
7986 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7987 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007988 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7989 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007990 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007991 return QualType();
7992 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7993 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7994 // arguments.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007995 RHSTypeArgs = {};
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007996 anyChanges = true;
7997 }
7998
7999 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
8000 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
8001 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
8002 Protocols);
8003 if (!Protocols.empty())
8004 anyChanges = true;
8005
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00008006 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
8007 // build a new result type.
8008 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008009 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008010 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00008011 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008012 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
8013 }
8014
8015 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
8016 }
8017
8018 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
8019 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
8020 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
8021 break;
8022
8023 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8024 }
8025
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00008026 return QualType();
8027}
8028
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008029bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
8030 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
8031 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
8032 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
8033
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008034 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
8035 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008036 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
8037 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
8038 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008039 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008040
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008041 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
8042 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
8043 // LHS).
8044 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008045 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
8046 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
8047 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
8048 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
8049 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
8050 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
8051 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
8052 // qualifiers.
8053 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008054 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008055 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
8056 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00008057 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008058
8059 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
8060 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
8061 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
8062 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
8063 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
8064 break;
8065 }
8066 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
8067 return false;
8068 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008069 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008070
8071 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
8072 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
8073 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
8074 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
8075 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
8076 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
8077 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8078
8079 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008080 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00008081 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
8082 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008083 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008084 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008085 }
8086 }
8087
8088 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008089}
8090
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008091bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8092 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008093 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8094 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008095
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008096 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008097 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008098
8099 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
8100 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008101}
8102
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00008103bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
8104 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
8105 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8106 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
8107}
8108
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008109/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008110/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008111/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008112/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008113bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
8114 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008115 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008116 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00008117
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008118 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008119}
8120
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00008121bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00008122 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00008123}
8124
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008125bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8126 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
8127}
8128
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008129/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
8130/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
8131/// QualType()
8132QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
8133 bool OfBlockPointer,
8134 bool Unqualified) {
8135 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
8136 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
8137 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00008138 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
8139 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008140 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8141 if (!MT.isNull())
8142 return MT;
8143 }
8144 }
8145 }
8146
8147 return QualType();
8148}
8149
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008150/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
8151/// parameter types
8152QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
8153 bool OfBlockPointer,
8154 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008155 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
8156 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
8157 // type is compatible with a union member
8158 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
8159 Unqualified);
8160 if (!lmerge.isNull())
8161 return lmerge;
8162
8163 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
8164 Unqualified);
8165 if (!rmerge.isNull())
8166 return rmerge;
8167
8168 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8169}
8170
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008171QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008172 bool OfBlockPointer,
8173 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008174 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
8175 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008176 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
8177 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008178 bool allLTypes = true;
8179 bool allRTypes = true;
8180
8181 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008182 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008183 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008184 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
8185 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008186 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
8187 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
8188 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008189 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008190 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008191 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008192 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008193 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008194 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008195
8196 if (Unqualified)
8197 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
8198
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008199 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
8200 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008201 if (Unqualified) {
8202 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
8203 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
8204 }
8205
8206 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008207 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008208 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008209 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008210
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00008211 // FIXME: double check this
8212 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
8213 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
8214 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00008215 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
8216 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008217
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00008218 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008219 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00008220 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008221
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008222 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00008223 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
8224 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008225 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
8226 return QualType();
8227
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008228 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
8229 return QualType();
Oren Ben Simhon318a6ea2017-04-27 12:01:00 +00008230 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != rbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs())
8231 return QualType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008232
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008233 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
8234 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008235
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00008236 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
8237 allLTypes = false;
8238 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
8239 allRTypes = false;
8240
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008241 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008242
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008243 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00008244 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
8245 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008246 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
8247 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008248 return QualType();
8249
8250 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
8251 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
8252 return QualType();
8253
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00008254 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
8255 return QualType();
8256
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008257 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> newParamInfos;
8258 bool canUseLeft, canUseRight;
8259 if (!mergeExtParameterInfo(lproto, rproto, canUseLeft, canUseRight,
8260 newParamInfos))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008261 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008262
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008263 if (!canUseLeft)
8264 allLTypes = false;
8265 if (!canUseRight)
8266 allRTypes = false;
8267
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008268 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008269 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008270 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
8271 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
8272 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
8273 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
8274 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8275 if (paramType.isNull())
8276 return QualType();
8277
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008278 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008279 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
8280
8281 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008282 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008283 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
8284 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008285 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008286
8287 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008288 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008289 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008290 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008291 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008292
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008293 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8294 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008295
8296 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
8297 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008298 EPI.ExtParameterInfos =
8299 newParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : newParamInfos.data();
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008300 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008301 }
8302
8303 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
8304 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
8305
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008306 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008307 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00008308 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008309 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
8310 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
8311 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
8312 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
8313 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
8314 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008315 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
8316 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008317
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00008318 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00008319 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008320 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
8321 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8322 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00008323 return QualType();
8324 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008325
8326 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
8327 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008328 return QualType();
8329 }
8330
8331 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8332 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008333
8334 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
8335 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008336 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008337 }
8338
8339 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8340 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008341 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008342}
8343
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008344/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
8345static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
8346 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
8347 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
8348 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
8349 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
8350 // type.
8351 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8352 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
8353 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
8354 return other;
8355
8356 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
8357 // integral type of the same size.
8358 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
8359 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
8360 return other;
8361
8362 return QualType();
8363}
8364
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008365QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008366 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008367 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00008368 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
8369 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
8370 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008371 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
8372 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008373 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
8374 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008375
8376 if (Unqualified) {
8377 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8378 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8379 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008380
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008381 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8382 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8383
8384 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8385 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8386 return LHS;
8387
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008388 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00008389 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8390 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008391 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8392 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
8393 // mismatch.
8394 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008395 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
Roger Ferrer Ibanezd93add32017-02-24 08:41:09 +00008396 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime() ||
8397 LQuals.hasUnaligned() != RQuals.hasUnaligned())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008398 return QualType();
8399
8400 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8401 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8402 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8403 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8404 // qualified __strong.
8405 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8406 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8407 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8408
8409 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8410 return QualType();
8411
8412 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8413 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
8414 }
8415 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8416 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
8417 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008418 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008419 }
8420
8421 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008422
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00008423 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
8424 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008425
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008426 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
8427 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
8428 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
8429 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00008430
8431 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008432 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8433 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
8434 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8435 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008436
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008437 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
8438 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8439 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8440
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00008441 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
8442 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
8443 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008444
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008445 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008446 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008447 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
8448 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008449 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008450 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008451 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008452 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008453 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008454 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008455 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00008456 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
8457 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
8458 return LHS;
8459 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
8460 return RHS;
8461 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008462
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008463 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008464 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008465
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00008466 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008467 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008468#define TYPE(Class, Base)
8469#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00008470#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008471#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8472#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8473#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008474 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008475
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00008476 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00008477 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008478 case Type::LValueReference:
8479 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008480 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008481 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008482
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008483 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008484 case Type::IncompleteArray:
8485 case Type::VariableArray:
8486 case Type::FunctionProto:
8487 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008488 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008489
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008490 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008491 {
8492 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008493 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8494 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008495 if (Unqualified) {
8496 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8497 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8498 }
8499 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
8500 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008501 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008502 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008503 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008504 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008505 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008506 return getPointerType(ResultType);
8507 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008508 case Type::BlockPointer:
8509 {
8510 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008511 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8512 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008513 if (Unqualified) {
8514 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8515 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8516 }
Anastasia Stulova81a25e352017-03-10 15:23:07 +00008517 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8518 Qualifiers LHSPteeQual = LHSPointee.getQualifiers();
8519 Qualifiers RHSPteeQual = RHSPointee.getQualifiers();
8520 // Blocks can't be an expression in a ternary operator (OpenCL v2.0
8521 // 6.12.5) thus the following check is asymmetric.
8522 if (!LHSPteeQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RHSPteeQual))
8523 return QualType();
8524 LHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
8525 RHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
8526 LHSPointee =
8527 QualType(LHSPointee.getTypePtr(), LHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
8528 RHSPointee =
8529 QualType(RHSPointee.getTypePtr(), RHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
8530 }
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008531 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
8532 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008533 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8534 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8535 return LHS;
8536 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8537 return RHS;
8538 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
8539 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00008540 case Type::Atomic:
8541 {
8542 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
8543 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8544 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8545 if (Unqualified) {
8546 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8547 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8548 }
8549 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
8550 Unqualified);
8551 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8552 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8553 return LHS;
8554 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8555 return RHS;
8556 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
8557 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008558 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008559 {
8560 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
8561 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
8562 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
8563 return QualType();
8564
8565 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
8566 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008567 if (Unqualified) {
8568 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8569 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8570 }
8571
8572 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008573 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008574 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8575 return LHS;
8576 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8577 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008578 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
8579 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
8580 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
8581 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008582 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
8583 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008584 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8585 return LHS;
8586 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8587 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008588 if (LVAT) {
8589 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8590 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
8591 // has to be different.
8592 return LHS;
8593 }
8594 if (RVAT) {
8595 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8596 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
8597 // has to be different.
8598 return RHS;
8599 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008600 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
8601 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00008602 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
8603 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008604 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008605 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008606 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008607 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008608 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008609 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008610 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008611 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008612 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00008613 case Type::Complex:
8614 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
8615 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008616 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008617 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00008618 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
8619 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008620 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008621 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008622 case Type::ObjCObject: {
8623 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008624 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
8625 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008626 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8627 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8628 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00008629 return LHS;
8630
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008631 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00008632 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008633 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008634 if (OfBlockPointer) {
8635 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8636 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008637 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8638 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008639 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008640 return QualType();
8641 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008642 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8643 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008644 return LHS;
8645
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00008646 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008647 case Type::Pipe:
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00008648 assert(LHS != RHS &&
8649 "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!");
8650 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008651 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008652
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008653 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008654}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00008655
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008656bool ASTContext::mergeExtParameterInfo(
8657 const FunctionProtoType *FirstFnType, const FunctionProtoType *SecondFnType,
8658 bool &CanUseFirst, bool &CanUseSecond,
8659 SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> &NewParamInfos) {
8660 assert(NewParamInfos.empty() && "param info list not empty");
8661 CanUseFirst = CanUseSecond = true;
8662 bool FirstHasInfo = FirstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8663 bool SecondHasInfo = SecondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8664
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008665 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008666 // we match if and only if the second type also doesn't have them.
8667 if (!FirstHasInfo && !SecondHasInfo)
8668 return true;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008669
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008670 bool NeedParamInfo = false;
8671 size_t E = FirstHasInfo ? FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size()
8672 : SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size();
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008673
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008674 for (size_t I = 0; I < E; ++I) {
8675 FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo FirstParam, SecondParam;
8676 if (FirstHasInfo)
8677 FirstParam = FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
8678 if (SecondHasInfo)
8679 SecondParam = SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008680
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008681 // Cannot merge unless everything except the noescape flag matches.
8682 if (FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(false) != SecondParam.withIsNoEscape(false))
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008683 return false;
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008684
8685 bool FirstNoEscape = FirstParam.isNoEscape();
8686 bool SecondNoEscape = SecondParam.isNoEscape();
8687 bool IsNoEscape = FirstNoEscape && SecondNoEscape;
8688 NewParamInfos.push_back(FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(IsNoEscape));
8689 if (NewParamInfos.back().getOpaqueValue())
8690 NeedParamInfo = true;
8691 if (FirstNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
8692 CanUseFirst = false;
8693 if (SecondNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
8694 CanUseSecond = false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008695 }
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008696
8697 if (!NeedParamInfo)
8698 NewParamInfos.clear();
8699
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008700 return true;
8701}
8702
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00008703void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
8704 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
8705}
8706
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008707/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
8708/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
8709/// return types.
8710QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8711 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8712 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8713 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8714 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8715 return LHS;
8716 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
8717 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
8718 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008719 QualType OldReturnType =
8720 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008721 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008722 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008723 QualType ResReturnType =
8724 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
8725 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
8726 return QualType();
8727 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
8728 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
8729 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
8730 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
8731 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008732 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8733 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00008734 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008735 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008736 return ResultType;
8737 }
8738 }
8739 return QualType();
8740 }
8741
8742 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
8743 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8744 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8745 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8746 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
8747 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
8748 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
8749 return QualType();
8750
8751 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8752 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8753 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8754 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8755 // qualified __strong.
8756 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8757 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8758 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8759
8760 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8761 return QualType();
8762
8763 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
8764 return LHS;
8765 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
8766 return RHS;
8767 return QualType();
8768 }
8769
8770 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8771 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8772 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8773 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
8774 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
8775 return LHS;
8776 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
8777 return RHS;
8778 }
8779 return QualType();
8780}
8781
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00008782//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008783// Integer Predicates
8784//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00008785
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008786unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00008787 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00008788 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00008789 if (T->isBooleanType())
8790 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00008791 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008792 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8793}
8794
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008795QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008796 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008797
8798 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8799 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8800 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008801 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008802
8803 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8804 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008805 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008806
8807 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8808 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008809 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8810 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8811 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8812 return UnsignedCharTy;
8813 case BuiltinType::Short:
8814 return UnsignedShortTy;
8815 case BuiltinType::Int:
8816 return UnsignedIntTy;
8817 case BuiltinType::Long:
8818 return UnsignedLongTy;
8819 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8820 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008821 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8822 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008823 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008824 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008825 }
8826}
8827
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008828ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() = default;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008829
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008830void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8831 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008832
8833//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8834// Builtin Type Computation
8835//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8836
8837/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008838/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8839/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8840/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8841/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008842///
8843/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8844/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008845static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008846 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00008847 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008848 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008849 // Modifiers.
8850 int HowLong = 0;
8851 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008852 RequiresICE = false;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00008853
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008854 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008855 bool Done = false;
8856 #ifndef NDEBUG
8857 bool IsSpecialLong = false;
8858 #endif
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008859 while (!Done) {
8860 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008861 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008862 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008863 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008864 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008865 case 'S':
8866 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8867 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8868 Signed = true;
8869 break;
8870 case 'U':
8871 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008872 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008873 Unsigned = true;
8874 break;
8875 case 'L':
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008876 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use 'L' with 'W' or 'N' modifiers");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008877 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8878 ++HowLong;
8879 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008880 case 'N':
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008881 // 'N' behaves like 'L' for all non LP64 targets and 'int' otherwise.
8882 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!");
8883 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'N' modifiers!");
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008884 #ifndef NDEBUG
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008885 IsSpecialLong = true;
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008886 #endif
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008887 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32)
8888 ++HowLong;
8889 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008890 case 'W':
8891 // This modifier represents int64 type.
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008892 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!");
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008893 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008894 #ifndef NDEBUG
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008895 IsSpecialLong = true;
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008896 #endif
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008897 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8898 default:
8899 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8900 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8901 HowLong = 1;
8902 break;
8903 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8904 HowLong = 2;
8905 break;
8906 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitheae8caa2017-06-14 21:26:31 +00008907 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008908 }
8909 }
8910
8911 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008912
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008913 // Read the base type.
8914 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008915 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008916 case 'v':
8917 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8918 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8919 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8920 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008921 case 'h':
8922 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008923 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008924 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8925 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008926 case 'f':
8927 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8928 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8929 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8930 break;
8931 case 'd':
Benjamin Kramerdfecbe92018-01-06 21:49:54 +00008932 assert(HowLong < 3 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008933 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
Benjamin Kramerdfecbe92018-01-06 21:49:54 +00008934 if (HowLong == 1)
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008935 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Benjamin Kramerdfecbe92018-01-06 21:49:54 +00008936 else if (HowLong == 2)
8937 Type = Context.Float128Ty;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008938 else
8939 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8940 break;
8941 case 's':
8942 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8943 if (Unsigned)
8944 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8945 else
8946 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8947 break;
8948 case 'i':
8949 if (HowLong == 3)
8950 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8951 else if (HowLong == 2)
8952 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8953 else if (HowLong == 1)
8954 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8955 else
8956 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8957 break;
8958 case 'c':
8959 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8960 if (Signed)
8961 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8962 else if (Unsigned)
8963 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8964 else
8965 Type = Context.CharTy;
8966 break;
8967 case 'b': // boolean
8968 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8969 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8970 break;
8971 case 'z': // size_t.
8972 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8973 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8974 break;
Richard Smith8110c9d2016-11-29 19:45:17 +00008975 case 'w': // wchar_t.
8976 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!");
8977 Type = Context.getWideCharType();
8978 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008979 case 'F':
8980 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8981 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008982 case 'G':
8983 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8984 break;
8985 case 'H':
8986 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8987 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008988 case 'M':
8989 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8990 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008991 case 'a':
8992 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8993 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8994 break;
8995 case 'A':
8996 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8997 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8998 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8999 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
9000 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
9001 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
9002 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
9003 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
9004 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
9005 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009006 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009007 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009008 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009009 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009010 break;
9011 case 'V': {
9012 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009013 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9014 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009015 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009016
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009017 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
9018 RequiresICE, false);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009019 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009020
9021 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00009022 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00009023 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009024 break;
9025 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009026 case 'E': {
9027 char *End;
9028
9029 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9030 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
9031
9032 Str = End;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009033
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009034 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009035 false);
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009036 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
9037 break;
9038 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00009039 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009040 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009041 false);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009042 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00009043 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
9044 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00009045 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009046 case 'Y':
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00009047 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
9048 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00009049 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00009050 Type = Context.getFILEType();
9051 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009052 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009053 return QualType();
9054 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009055 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00009056 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009057 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00009058 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009059 else
9060 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
9061
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009062 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009063 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009064 return QualType();
9065 }
9066 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00009067 case 'K':
9068 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
9069 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
9070
9071 if (Type.isNull()) {
9072 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
9073 return QualType();
9074 }
9075 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00009076 case 'p':
9077 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
9078 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00009079 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009080
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009081 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
9082 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009083 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00009084 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009085 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
9086 case '*':
9087 case '&': {
9088 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
9089 // qualified with an address space.
9090 char *End;
9091 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9092 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009093 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type,
9094 getLangASFromTargetAS(AddrSpace));
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009095 Str = End;
9096 }
9097 if (c == '*')
9098 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
9099 else
9100 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
9101 break;
9102 }
9103 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
9104 case 'C':
9105 Type = Type.withConst();
9106 break;
9107 case 'D':
9108 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
9109 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00009110 case 'R':
9111 Type = Type.withRestrict();
9112 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009113 }
9114 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00009115
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009116 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00009117 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009118
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009119 return Type;
9120}
9121
9122/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009123QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
9124 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
9125 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00009126 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009127
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009128 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009129
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009130 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009131 Error = GE_None;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009132 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
9133 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009134 if (Error != GE_None)
9135 return QualType();
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009136
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009137 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009138
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009139 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009140 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009141 if (Error != GE_None)
9142 return QualType();
9143
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009144 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
9145 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
9146 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
9147 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
9148
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009149 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
9150 if (Ty->isArrayType())
9151 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009152
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009153 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
9154 }
9155
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00009156 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
9157 return QualType();
9158
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009159 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
9160 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
9161
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009162 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009163 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
9164
9165 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
9166
Richard Smith836de6b2016-12-19 23:59:34 +00009167 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here.
9168 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009169 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00009170
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00009171 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009172 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
9173 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
Richard Smith391fb862016-10-18 07:13:55 +00009174 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
9175 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
9176 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00009177
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00009178 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009179}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00009180
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009181static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
9182 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009183 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009184 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009185
Richard Smithe2467b72017-11-16 23:54:56 +00009186 // Non-user-provided functions get emitted as weak definitions with every
9187 // use, no matter whether they've been explicitly instantiated etc.
9188 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
9189 if (!MD->isUserProvided())
9190 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9191
Yaron Keren4cd211b2017-02-22 14:32:39 +00009192 GVALinkage External;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009193 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
9194 case TSK_Undeclared:
9195 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
9196 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
9197 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009198
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009199 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009200 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009201
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00009202 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
9203 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
9204 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
9205 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
9206 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
9207 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009208 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009209 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
9210
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009211 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009212 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009213 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009214 }
9215
9216 if (!FD->isInlined())
9217 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00009218
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00009219 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
9220 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009221 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00009222 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009223 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
9224
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009225 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
9226 // externally visible.
9227 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
9228 return External;
9229
9230 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009231 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009232 }
9233
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009234 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
9235 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
9236 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00009237 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009238 return GVA_StrongODR;
9239
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009240 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009241}
9242
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009243static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009244 const Decl *D, GVALinkage L) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009245 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
9246 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
9247 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
9248 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
9249 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009250 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009251 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
9252 return GVA_StrongODR;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009253 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice &&
9254 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
9255 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
9256 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
9257 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal)
9258 return GVA_StrongODR;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009259 }
9260 return L;
9261}
9262
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009263/// Adjust the GVALinkage for a declaration based on what an external AST source
9264/// knows about whether there can be other definitions of this declaration.
9265static GVALinkage
9266adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext &Ctx, const Decl *D,
9267 GVALinkage L) {
9268 ExternalASTSource *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
9269 if (!Source)
9270 return L;
9271
9272 switch (Source->hasExternalDefinitions(D)) {
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009273 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never:
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009274 // Other translation units rely on us to provide the definition.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009275 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
9276 return GVA_StrongODR;
9277 break;
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009278
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009279 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always:
9280 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009281
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009282 case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy:
9283 break;
9284 }
9285 return L;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009286}
9287
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009288GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
9289 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, FD,
9290 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, FD,
9291 basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD)));
9292}
9293
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009294static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
9295 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009296 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
9297 return GVA_Internal;
9298
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009299 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009300 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
9301 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
9302 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
9303
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00009304 // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl
9305 // LexicalContext.
9306 if (!LexicalContext)
9307 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009308
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00009309 // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the
9310 // nearest enclosing function.
9311 auto StaticLocalLinkage =
9312 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
9313
9314 // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must
9315 // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it
9316 // contains, whether inline or out-of-line."
9317 // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use
9318 // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are
9319 // known/supported currently.
9320 if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ||
9321 StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
9322 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9323 return StaticLocalLinkage;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009324 }
9325
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009326 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
9327 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
9328 // cause link errors.
9329 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
9330 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9331
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00009332 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
9333 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
9334 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
9335 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
9336 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
9337 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
9338 break;
9339 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
9340 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009341 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00009342 break;
9343 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
9344 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
9345 break;
9346 }
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009347
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00009348 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009349 case TSK_Undeclared:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009350 return StrongLinkage;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009351
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009352 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00009353 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
9354 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009355 ? GVA_StrongODR
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009356 : StrongLinkage;
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009357
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009358 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009359 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009360
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009361 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
9362 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
9363
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009364 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009365 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009366 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00009367
9368 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009369}
9370
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009371GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009372 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, VD,
9373 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, VD,
9374 basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD)));
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009375}
9376
David Blaikiee6b7c282017-04-11 20:46:34 +00009377bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009378 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
9379 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
9380 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00009381 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
9382 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
9383 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009384 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
9385 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
9386 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009387 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9388 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
9389 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
9390 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009391 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
9392 return true;
Dmitry Polukhin0b0da292016-04-06 11:38:59 +00009393 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D) ||
9394 D->hasAttr<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr>())
9395 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00009396 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
9397 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009398 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00009399 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
9400 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
9401 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +00009402 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
9403 return true;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00009404 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009405 return false;
9406
9407 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
9408 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009409 return false;
9410
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009411 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
9412 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
9413 return false;
9414
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009415 // Aliases and used decls are required.
9416 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9417 return true;
9418
9419 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9420 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00009421 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00009422 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009423
9424 // Constructors and destructors are required.
9425 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
9426 return true;
9427
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00009428 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
9429 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
9430 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
9431 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
9432 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
9433 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
9434 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
9435 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
9436 return true;
9437 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009438 }
9439 }
9440
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009441 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
9442
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009443 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
9444 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
9445 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009446 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009447 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00009448
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009449 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
9450 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
9451
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009452 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
9453 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009454 return false;
9455
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009456 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009457 auto Linkage = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
9458 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009459 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009460
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009461 // We never need to emit a variable that is available in another TU.
9462 if (Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
9463 return false;
9464
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009465 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
9466 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
9467 return true;
9468
9469 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009470 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
Richard Smith187ffb42017-01-20 01:19:46 +00009471 // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery.
9472 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009473 return true;
9474
Richard Smithda383632016-08-15 01:33:41 +00009475 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
9476 // bindings have side-effects.
9477 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
9478 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
9479 if (auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
9480 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
9481 return true;
9482
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009483 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009484}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00009485
Erich Keane281d20b2018-01-08 21:34:17 +00009486void ASTContext::forEachMultiversionedFunctionVersion(
9487 const FunctionDecl *FD,
9488 llvm::function_ref<void(const FunctionDecl *)> Pred) const {
9489 assert(FD->isMultiVersion() && "Only valid for multiversioned functions");
9490 llvm::SmallDenseSet<const FunctionDecl*, 4> SeenDecls;
9491 FD = FD->getCanonicalDecl();
9492 for (auto *CurDecl :
9493 FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->lookup(FD->getDeclName())) {
9494 FunctionDecl *CurFD = CurDecl->getAsFunction()->getCanonicalDecl();
9495 if (CurFD && hasSameType(CurFD->getType(), FD->getType()) &&
9496 std::end(SeenDecls) == llvm::find(SeenDecls, CurFD)) {
9497 SeenDecls.insert(CurFD);
9498 Pred(CurFD);
9499 }
9500 }
9501}
9502
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009503CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
9504 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009505 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009506 if (IsCXXMethod)
9507 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00009508
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009509 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
9510 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
9511 break;
9512 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
9513 return CC_C;
9514 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
Erich Keane5759fa72017-10-24 23:12:01 +00009515 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2") && !IsVariadic)
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009516 return CC_X86FastCall;
9517 break;
9518 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
9519 if (!IsVariadic)
9520 return CC_X86StdCall;
9521 break;
9522 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
9523 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9524 if (!IsVariadic)
9525 return CC_X86VectorCall;
9526 break;
Erich Keanea957ffb2017-11-02 21:08:00 +00009527 case LangOptions::DCC_RegCall:
9528 // __regcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9529 if (!IsVariadic)
9530 return CC_X86RegCall;
9531 break;
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009532 }
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00009533 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009534}
9535
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00009536bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00009537 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
9538 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
9539}
9540
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00009541VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
9542 if (!VTContext.get()) {
9543 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9544 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
9545 else
9546 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
9547 }
9548 return VTContext.get();
9549}
9550
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009551MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009552 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00009553 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009554 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
9555 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00009556 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009557 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00009558 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00009559 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00009560 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009561 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009562 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009563 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009564 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009565 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009566}
9567
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009568CXXABI::~CXXABI() = default;
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009569
9570size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00009571 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
9572 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
9573 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
9574 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
9575 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
9576 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
9577 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
9578 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
9579 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
9580 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
9581 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
9582 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
9583 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
9584 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009585}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009586
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009587/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
9588/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
9589/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
9590/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9591QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
9592 unsigned Signed) const {
9593 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
9594 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
9595 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
9596 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
9597 return QualTy;
9598}
9599
9600/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
9601/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
9602/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9603QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
9604 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
9605 switch (Ty) {
9606 case TargetInfo::Float:
9607 return FloatTy;
9608 case TargetInfo::Double:
9609 return DoubleTy;
9610 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
9611 return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00009612 case TargetInfo::Float128:
9613 return Float128Ty;
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009614 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
9615 return QualType();
9616 }
9617
9618 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
9619}
9620
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009621void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
9622 if (Number > 1)
9623 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009624}
9625
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009626unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009627 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009628 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009629}
9630
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009631void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
9632 if (Number > 1)
9633 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
9634}
9635
9636unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009637 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009638 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
9639}
9640
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009641MangleNumberingContext &
9642ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009643 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009644 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009645 if (!MCtx)
9646 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
9647 return *MCtx;
9648}
9649
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009650std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
9651ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009652 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00009653}
9654
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00009655const CXXConstructorDecl *
9656ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
9657 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9658 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
9659}
9660
9661void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
9662 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
9663 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9664 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
9665 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
9666}
9667
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00009668void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9669 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
9670 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9671}
9672
9673TypedefNameDecl *
9674ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9675 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9676}
9677
9678void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9679 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
9680 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9681}
9682
9683DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9684 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9685}
9686
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009687void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
9688 ParamIndices[D] = index;
9689}
9690
9691unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
9692 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
9693 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
9694 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
9695 return I->second;
9696}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009697
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009698APValue *
9699ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
9700 bool MayCreate) {
9701 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
9702 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009703 if (MayCreate) {
9704 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
9705 if (!MTVI)
9706 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
9707 return MTVI;
9708 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009709
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009710 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009711}
9712
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009713bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
9714 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
9715 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
9716 return false;
9717
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00009718 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
9719 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
9720 return false;
9721
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009722 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
9723 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
9724 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
9725 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
9726 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
9727 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
9728 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
9729}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009730
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009731static ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009732 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009733 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009734 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009735 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009736 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009737 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009738}
9739
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009740namespace {
9741
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009742/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
9743/// @{
9744template <typename T>
9745ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
9746 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
9747}
9748template <>
9749ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
9750 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9751}
9752template <>
9753ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
9754createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
9755 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9756}
9757/// @}
9758
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009759 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
9760 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
9761 ///
9762 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
9763 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
9764 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
9765 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009766 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009767 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009768 public:
9769 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
9770 ///
9771 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009772 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
9773 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
9774 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
9775 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
9776 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009777 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009778 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009779 }
9780
9781 private:
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009782 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
9783
9784 using VisitorBase = RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009785
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009786 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
9787 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
9788 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009789
9790 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
9791 return true;
9792 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009793
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009794 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
9795 return true;
9796 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009797
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009798 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
9799 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009800 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009801 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00009802 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009803 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009804 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009805 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
9806 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
9807 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
9808 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
9809 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
9810 // new matches.
9811 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
9812 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
9813 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
9814 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009815 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009816 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009817 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
9818 NodeOrVector = D;
9819 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
9820 NodeOrVector = S;
9821 else
9822 NodeOrVector =
9823 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009824 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009825 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
9826 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
9827 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Gabor Horvath10a837a2017-04-19 15:11:10 +00009828 delete NodeOrVector
9829 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00009830 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009831 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009832
9833 auto *Vector =
9834 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
9835 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
9836 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
9837 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
9838 // types.
9839 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
9840 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
9841 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
9842 if (!Found)
9843 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009844 }
9845 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009846 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009847 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009848 ParentStack.pop_back();
9849 return Result;
9850 }
9851
9852 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009853 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
9854 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009855 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009856 }
9857
9858 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009859 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
9860 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009861 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009862 }
9863
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009864 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009865 return TraverseNode(
9866 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
9867 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
9868 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009869 }
9870
9871 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
9872 return TraverseNode(
9873 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009874 [&] {
9875 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
9876 },
9877 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009878 }
9879
9880 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
9881 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009882 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009883 };
9884
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009885} // namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009886
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009887template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
9888static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
9889 const MapTy &Map) {
9890 auto I = Map.find(Node);
9891 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009892 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009893 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009894 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009895 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009896 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009897 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009898}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009899
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009900ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
9901ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
9902 if (!PointerParents) {
9903 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
9904 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
9905 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
9906 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
9907 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
9908 }
9909 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
9910 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
9911 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
9912}
9913
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009914bool
9915ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
9916 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
9917 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
9918 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
9919 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
9920 return false;
9921 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
9922 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9923 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009924 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009925 return false;
9926
9927 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9928 return false;
9929
9930 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9931 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9932 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9933 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9934 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9935 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9936 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9937 return false;
9938 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9939 return false;
9940 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009941
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009942 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009943}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009944
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009945uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const {
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009946 LangAS AS;
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009947 if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType())
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009948 AS = LangAS::Default;
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009949 else
9950 AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9951
9952 return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS);
9953}
9954
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009955unsigned ASTContext::getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const {
9956 if (isTargetAddressSpace(AS))
9957 return toTargetAddressSpace(AS);
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +00009958 else
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009959 return (*AddrSpaceMap)[(unsigned)AS];
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +00009960}
9961
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009962// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9963// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9964template
9965clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9966 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9967clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9968 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9969 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);